import gdb-1999-08-30 snapshot
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988-1999
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c
5 @c %**start of header
6 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8 @setfilename gdb.info
9 @c
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c
12 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
13 @setchapternewpage odd
14 @c %**end of header
15
16 @iftex
17 @c @smallbook
18 @c @cropmarks
19 @end iftex
20
21 @finalout
22 @syncodeindex ky cp
23
24 @c readline appendices use @vindex
25 @syncodeindex vr cp
26
27 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
28 @set EDITION Seventh
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's revision date
31 @set DATE February 1999
32
33 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO-2 macros and info-makers to format properly.
34
35 @ifinfo
36 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
37 @c manuals to an info tree. zoo@cygnus.com is developing this facility.
38 @format
39 START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
40 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
41 END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
42 @end format
43 @end ifinfo
44 @c
45 @c
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
51 of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
52 for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
55
56 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
57 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
58 are preserved on all copies.
59
60 @ignore
61 Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
62 results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
63 notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
64 (this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
65
66 @end ignore
67 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
68 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
69 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
70 permission notice identical to this one.
71
72 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
73 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
74 @end ifinfo
75
76 @titlepage
77 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
79 @sp 1
80 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81 @subtitle @value{DATE}
82 @author Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch
83 @page
84 @tex
85 {\parskip=0pt
86 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
87 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
88 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
89 }
90 @end tex
91
92 @c ISBN seems to be wrong...
93
94 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
95 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
96 @sp 2
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
99 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
100 Printed copies are available for $20 each. @*
101 ISBN 1-882114-11-6 @*
102
103 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
104 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
105 are preserved on all copies.
106
107 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
108 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
109 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
110 permission notice identical to this one.
111
112 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
113 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
114 @end titlepage
115 @page
116
117 @ifinfo
118 @node Top
119 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
120
121 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
122
123 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
124 @value{GDBVN}.
125
126 Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
127 @menu
128 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
129 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
130
131 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
132 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
133 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
134 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
135 * Stack:: Examining the stack
136 * Source:: Examining source files
137 * Data:: Examining data
138
139 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
140
141 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
142 * Altering:: Altering execution
143 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
144 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
145 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
148 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
149
150 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
151 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
152
153 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
154 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
155 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
156 * Index:: Index
157 @end menu
158
159 @end ifinfo
160
161 @node Summary
162 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
163
164 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
165 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
166 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
167
168 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
169 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
170
171 @itemize @bullet
172 @item
173 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
174
175 @item
176 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
177
178 @item
179 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
180
181 @item
182 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
183 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
184 @end itemize
185
186 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
187 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
188 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
189
190 @cindex Chill
191 @cindex Modula-2
192 Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
193 see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
194
195 @cindex Pascal
196 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
197 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
198 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
199 syntax.
200
201 @cindex Fortran
202 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
203 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
204 underscore.
205
206 @menu
207 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
208 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
209 @end menu
210
211 @node Free Software
212 @unnumberedsec Free software
213
214 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
215 General Public License
216 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
217 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
218 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
219 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
220 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
221 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
222
223 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
224 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
225 from anyone else.
226
227 @node Contributors
228 @unnumberedsec Contributors to GDB
229
230 Richard Stallman was the original author of GDB, and of many other
231 @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its development.
232 This section attempts to credit major contributors. One of the virtues
233 of free software is that everyone is free to contribute to it; with
234 regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The file
235 @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
236 blow-by-blow account.
237
238 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
239
240 @quotation
241 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
242 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
243 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
244 @end quotation
245
246 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
247 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
248 releases:
249 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
250 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
251 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
252 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
253 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
254 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
255 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
256 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
257
258 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
259 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
260
261 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in GDB,
262 with significant additional contributions from Per Bothner. James
263 Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on C++ was by Peter
264 TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading to release 3.0).
265
266 @value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
267 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
268 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
269
270 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
271 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
272
273 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
274
275 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
276 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
277 support.
278 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
279 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
280 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
281 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
282 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
283 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
284 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
285 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
286 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
287 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
288 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
289 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
290 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
291 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
292 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
293
294 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
295
296 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
297 libraries.
298
299 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
300 about several machine instruction sets.
301
302 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
303 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
304 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
305 and RDI targets, respectively.
306
307 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
308 command-line editing and command history.
309
310 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
311 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
312
313 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
314 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
315 symbols.
316
317 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
318 Super-H processors.
319
320 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
321
322 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
323
324 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
325
326 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
327
328 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors
329
330 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
331 watchpoints.
332
333 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
334
335 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
336
337 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
338 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout GDB.
339
340 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
341 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
342 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
343 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
344 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
345 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
346 information in this manual.
347
348 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored GDB maintenance and much of its
349 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on GDB
350 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Edith Epstein,
351 Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu
352 Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler, Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey
353 Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan
354 Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In addition, Dave Brolley, Ian
355 Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton, JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ
356 Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug Evans, Sean Fagan, David
357 Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke,
358 Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner, Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore,
359 Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith,
360 Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron
361 Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David Zuhn have made contributions both large
362 and small.
363
364
365 @node Sample Session
366 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
367
368 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
369 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
370 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
371
372 @iftex
373 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
374 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
375 @end iftex
376
377 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
378 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
379
380 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
381 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
382 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
383 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
384 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
385 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
386 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
387 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
388 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
389
390 @smallexample
391 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
392 $ @b{./m4}
393 @b{define(foo,0000)}
394
395 @b{foo}
396 0000
397 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
398
399 @b{bar}
400 0000
401 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
402
403 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
404 @b{baz}
405 @b{C-d}
406 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
407 @end smallexample
408
409 @noindent
410 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
411
412 @smallexample
413 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
414 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
415 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
416 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
417 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
418 the conditions.
419 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
420 for details.
421
422 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
423 (@value{GDBP})
424 @end smallexample
425
426 @noindent
427 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
428 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
429 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
430 that examples fit in this manual.
431
432 @smallexample
433 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
434 @end smallexample
435
436 @noindent
437 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
438 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
439 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
440 @code{break} command.
441
442 @smallexample
443 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
444 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
445 @end smallexample
446
447 @noindent
448 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
449 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
450 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
451
452 @smallexample
453 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
454 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
455 @b{define(foo,0000)}
456
457 @b{foo}
458 0000
459 @end smallexample
460
461 @noindent
462 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
463 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
464 context where it stops.
465
466 @smallexample
467 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
468
469 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
470 at builtin.c:879
471 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
472 @end smallexample
473
474 @noindent
475 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
476 the next line of the current function.
477
478 @smallexample
479 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
480 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
481 : nil,
482 @end smallexample
483
484 @noindent
485 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
486 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
487 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
488 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
489
490 @smallexample
491 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
492 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
493 at input.c:530
494 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
495 @end smallexample
496
497 @noindent
498 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
499 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
500 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
501 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
502 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
503 stack frame for each active subroutine.
504
505 @smallexample
506 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
507 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
508 at input.c:530
509 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
510 at builtin.c:882
511 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
512 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
513 at macro.c:71
514 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
515 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
516 @end smallexample
517
518 @noindent
519 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
520 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
521 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
522
523 @smallexample
524 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
525 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
526 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
527 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
528 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
529 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
530 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
531 : xstrdup(rq);
532 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
534 @end smallexample
535
536 @noindent
537 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
538 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
539 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
540 (@code{print}) to see their values.
541
542 @smallexample
543 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
544 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
545 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
546 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
547 @end smallexample
548
549 @noindent
550 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
551 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
552 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
553
554 @smallexample
555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
556 533 xfree(rquote);
557 534
558 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
559 : xstrdup (lq);
560 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
561 : xstrdup (rq);
562 537
563 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
564 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
565 540 @}
566 541
567 542 void
568 @end smallexample
569
570 @noindent
571 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
572 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
573
574 @smallexample
575 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
576 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
577 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
578 540 @}
579 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
580 $3 = 9
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
582 $4 = 7
583 @end smallexample
584
585 @noindent
586 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
587 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
588 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
589 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
590 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
591 assignments.
592
593 @smallexample
594 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
595 $5 = 7
596 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
597 $6 = 9
598 @end smallexample
599
600 @noindent
601 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
602 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
603 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
604 example that caused trouble initially:
605
606 @smallexample
607 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
608 Continuing.
609
610 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
611
612 baz
613 0000
614 @end smallexample
615
616 @noindent
617 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
618 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
619 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
620
621 @smallexample
622 @b{C-d}
623 Program exited normally.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
628 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
629 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
633 @end smallexample
634
635 @node Invocation
636 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
637
638 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
639 The essentials are:
640 @itemize @bullet
641 @item
642 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
643 @item
644 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
645 @end itemize
646
647 @menu
648 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
649 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
650 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
651 @end menu
652
653 @node Invoking GDB
654 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
655
656 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
657 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
658
659 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
660 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
661
662 The command-line options described here are designed
663 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
664 options may effectively be unavailable.
665
666 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
667 specifying an executable program:
668
669 @example
670 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
671 @end example
672
673 @noindent
674 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
675 specified:
676
677 @example
678 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
679 @end example
680
681 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
682 to debug a running process:
683
684 @example
685 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
686 @end example
687
688 @noindent
689 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
690 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
691
692 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
693 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote debugger
694 attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of ``process'',
695 and there is often no way to get a core dump.
696
697 You can run @code{gdb} without printing the front material, which describes
698 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
699
700 @smallexample
701 @value{GDBP} -silent
702 @end smallexample
703
704 @noindent
705 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
706 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
707
708 @noindent
709 Type
710
711 @example
712 @value{GDBP} -help
713 @end example
714
715 @noindent
716 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
717 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
718
719 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
720 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
721 @samp{-x} option is used.
722
723
724 @menu
725 * File Options:: Choosing files
726 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
727 @end menu
728
729 @node File Options
730 @subsection Choosing files
731
732 When @value{GDBN} starts
733 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
734 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
735 @samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
736 that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
737 @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
738 that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
739 the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
740
741 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
742 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
743 argument and ignore it.
744
745 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
746 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
747 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
748 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
749 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
750
751 @table @code
752 @item -symbols @var{file}
753 @itemx -s @var{file}
754 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
755
756 @item -exec @var{file}
757 @itemx -e @var{file}
758 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
759 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
760
761 @item -se @var{file}
762 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
763 file.
764
765 @item -core @var{file}
766 @itemx -c @var{file}
767 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
768
769 @item -c @var{number}
770 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
771 (unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
772 case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
773
774 @item -command @var{file}
775 @itemx -x @var{file}
776 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
777 Files,, Command files}.
778
779 @item -directory @var{directory}
780 @itemx -d @var{directory}
781 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
782
783 @item -m
784 @itemx -mapped
785 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
786 supported on all systems.}@*
787 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
788 system call, you can use this option
789 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
790 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
791 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{./fred.syms}.
792 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
793 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
794 the symbol table from the executable program.
795
796 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
797 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
798 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
799
800 @item -r
801 @itemx -readnow
802 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
803 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
804 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
805
806 @end table
807
808 The @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options are typically combined in
809 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
810 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for
811 information on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do
812 nothing but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
813
814 @example
815 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
816 @end example
817
818 @node Mode Options
819 @subsection Choosing modes
820
821 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
822 batch mode or quiet mode.
823
824 @table @code
825 @item -nx
826 @itemx -n
827 Do not execute commands from any initialization files (normally called
828 @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally, the commands in
829 these files are executed after all the command options and arguments
830 have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command files}.
831
832 @item -quiet
833 @itemx -q
834 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
835 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
836
837 @item -batch
838 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
839 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
840 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
841 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
842 in the command files.
843
844 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
845 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
846 more useful, the message
847
848 @example
849 Program exited normally.
850 @end example
851
852 @noindent
853 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
854 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
855
856 @item -cd @var{directory}
857 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
858 instead of the current directory.
859
860 @item -fullname
861 @itemx -f
862 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
863 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
864 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
865 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
866 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
867 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
868 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
869 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
870 frame.
871
872 @item -b @var{bps}
873 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
874 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
875
876 @item -tty @var{device}
877 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
878 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
879
880 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
881 @c @item -tui
882 @c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
883 @c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
884 @c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
885 @c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
886 @c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
887
888 @c @item -xdb
889 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
890 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
891 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
892 @c systems.
893
894 @end table
895
896 @node Quitting GDB
897 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
898 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
899 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
900
901 @table @code
902 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
903 @kindex q
904 @item quit
905 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated @code{q}), or
906 type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you do not supply
907 @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally; otherwise it will
908 terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the error code.
909 @end table
910
911 @cindex interrupt
912 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
913 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
914 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
915 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
916 until a time when it is safe.
917
918 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
919 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
920 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
921
922 @node Shell Commands
923 @section Shell commands
924
925 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
926 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
927 just use the @code{shell} command.
928
929 @table @code
930 @kindex shell
931 @cindex shell escape
932 @item shell @var{command string}
933 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
934 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
935 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses @code{/bin/sh}.
936 @end table
937
938 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
939 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
940 @value{GDBN}:
941
942 @table @code
943 @kindex make
944 @cindex calling make
945 @item make @var{make-args}
946 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
947 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
948 @end table
949
950 @node Commands
951 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
952
953 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
954 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
955 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
956 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
957 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
958
959 @menu
960 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
961 * Completion:: Command completion
962 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
963 @end menu
964
965 @node Command Syntax
966 @section Command syntax
967
968 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
969 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
970 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
971 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
972 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
973 with no arguments. Some command names do not allow any arguments.
974
975 @cindex abbreviation
976 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
977 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
978 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
979 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
980 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
981 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
982 arguments to the @code{help} command.
983
984 @cindex repeating commands
985 @kindex RET
986 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
987 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
988 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
989 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
990 repeat.
991
992 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
993 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
994 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
995
996 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
997 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
998 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
999 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1000 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1001
1002 @kindex #
1003 @cindex comment
1004 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1005 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1006 Files,,Command files}).
1007
1008 @node Completion
1009 @section Command completion
1010
1011 @cindex completion
1012 @cindex word completion
1013 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1014 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1015 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1016 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1017
1018 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1019 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1020 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1021 enter it). For example, if you type
1022
1023 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1024 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1025 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1026 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1027 @example
1028 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1029 @end example
1030
1031 @noindent
1032 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1033 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1034
1035 @example
1036 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1037 @end example
1038
1039 @noindent
1040 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1041 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1042 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1043 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1044 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1045 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1046
1047 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1048 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1049 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1050 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1051 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1052 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1053 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1054 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1055 example:
1056
1057 @example
1058 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1059 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1060 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1061 make_abs_section make_function_type
1062 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1063 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1064 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1065 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1066 @end example
1067
1068 @noindent
1069 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1070 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1071 command.
1072
1073 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1074 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1075 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1076 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1077 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1078
1079 @cindex quotes in commands
1080 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1081 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1082 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1083 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1084 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1085 @value{GDBN} commands.
1086
1087 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1088 name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1089 (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1090 type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1091 distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1092 @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1093 @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1094 facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1095 beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1096 consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1097 @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1098
1099 @example
1100 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @key{M-?}
1101 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1102 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1103 @end example
1104
1105 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1106 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1107 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1108 place:
1109
1110 @example
1111 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1112 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1113 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1114 @end example
1115
1116 @noindent
1117 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1118 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1119 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1120
1121 For more information about overloaded functions, @pxref{C plus plus
1122 expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1123 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1124 @pxref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
1125
1126
1127 @node Help
1128 @section Getting help
1129 @cindex online documentation
1130 @kindex help
1131
1132 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1133 using the command @code{help}.
1134
1135 @table @code
1136 @kindex h
1137 @item help
1138 @itemx h
1139 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1140 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1141
1142 @smallexample
1143 (@value{GDBP}) help
1144 List of classes of commands:
1145
1146 running -- Running the program
1147 stack -- Examining the stack
1148 data -- Examining data
1149 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1150 files -- Specifying and examining files
1151 status -- Status inquiries
1152 support -- Support facilities
1153 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1154 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1155 obscure -- Obscure features
1156
1157 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1158 commands in that class.
1159 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1160 documentation.
1161 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1162 (@value{GDBP})
1163 @end smallexample
1164
1165 @item help @var{class}
1166 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1167 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1168 help display for the class @code{status}:
1169
1170 @smallexample
1171 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1172 Status inquiries.
1173
1174 List of commands:
1175
1176 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1177 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1178 show -- Generic command for showing things set
1179 with "set"
1180 info -- Generic command for printing status
1181
1182 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1183 documentation.
1184 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1185 (@value{GDBP})
1186 @end smallexample
1187
1188 @item help @var{command}
1189 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1190 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1191
1192 @kindex complete
1193 @item complete @var{args}
1194 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1195 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1196 command you want completed. For example:
1197
1198 @smallexample
1199 complete i
1200 @end smallexample
1201
1202 @noindent results in:
1203
1204 @smallexample
1205 @group
1206 info
1207 inspect
1208 ignore
1209 @end group
1210 @end smallexample
1211
1212 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1213 @end table
1214
1215 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1216 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1217 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1218 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1219 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1220 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1221
1222 @c @group
1223 @table @code
1224 @kindex info
1225 @kindex i
1226 @item info
1227 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1228 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1229 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1230 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1231 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1232 @w{@code{help info}}.
1233
1234 @kindex set
1235 @item set
1236 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1237 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1238 @code{set prompt $}.
1239
1240 @kindex show
1241 @item show
1242 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1243 @value{GDBN} itself.
1244 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1245 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1246 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1247 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1248
1249 @kindex info set
1250 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1251 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1252 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1253 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1254 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1255 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1256 @end table
1257 @c @end group
1258
1259 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1260 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1261
1262 @table @code
1263 @kindex show version
1264 @cindex version number
1265 @item show version
1266 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1267 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of @value{GDBN} are in
1268 use at your site, you may occasionally want to determine which version
1269 of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new commands are introduced,
1270 and old ones may wither away. The version number is also announced
1271 when you start @value{GDBN}.
1272
1273 @kindex show copying
1274 @item show copying
1275 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1276
1277 @kindex show warranty
1278 @item show warranty
1279 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement.
1280 @end table
1281
1282 @node Running
1283 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1284
1285 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1286 debugging information when you compile it.
1287
1288 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1289 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1290 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1291 kill a child process.
1292
1293 @menu
1294 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1295 * Starting:: Starting your program
1296 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1297 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1298
1299 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1300 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1301 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1302 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1303
1304 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1305 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1306 @end menu
1307
1308 @node Compilation
1309 @section Compiling for debugging
1310
1311 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1312 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1313 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1314 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1315 and addresses in the executable code.
1316
1317 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1318 the compiler.
1319
1320 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1321 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1322 executables containing debugging information.
1323
1324 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1325 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1326 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1327 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1328 in pushing your luck.
1329
1330 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1331 @cindex debugging optimized code
1332 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1333 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1334 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1335 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1336 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1337 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1338
1339 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1340 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1341 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1342 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1343
1344 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1345 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1346 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1347
1348 @need 2000
1349 @node Starting
1350 @section Starting your program
1351 @cindex starting
1352 @cindex running
1353
1354 @table @code
1355 @kindex run
1356 @item run
1357 @itemx r
1358 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1359 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1360 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1361 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1362 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1363
1364 @end table
1365
1366 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1367 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1368 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1369 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1370
1371 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1372 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1373 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1374 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1375 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1376 divided into four categories:
1377
1378 @table @asis
1379 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1380 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1381 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1382 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1383 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1384 the arguments.
1385 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1386 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1387 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1388
1389 @item The @emph{environment.}
1390 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1391 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1392 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1393 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1394
1395 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1396 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1397 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1398 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1399
1400 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1401 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1402 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1403 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1404 set a different device for your program.
1405 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1406
1407 @cindex pipes
1408 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1409 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1410 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1411 wrong program.
1412 @end table
1413
1414 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1415 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1416 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1417 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1418 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1419
1420 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1421 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1422 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1423 your current breakpoints.
1424
1425 @node Arguments
1426 @section Your program's arguments
1427
1428 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1429 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1430 @code{run} command.
1431 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1432 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1433 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1434 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1435 @code{/bin/sh}.
1436
1437 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1438 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1439
1440 @kindex set args
1441 @table @code
1442 @item set args
1443 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1444 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1445 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1446 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1447 it again without arguments.
1448
1449 @kindex show args
1450 @item show args
1451 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1452 @end table
1453
1454 @node Environment
1455 @section Your program's environment
1456
1457 @cindex environment (of your program)
1458 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1459 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1460 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1461 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1462 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1463 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1464 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1465
1466 @table @code
1467 @kindex path
1468 @item path @var{directory}
1469 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1470 (the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
1471 You may specify several directory names, separated by @samp{:} or
1472 whitespace. If @var{directory} is already in the path, it is moved to
1473 the front, so it is searched sooner.
1474
1475 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1476 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1477 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1478 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1479 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1480 @var{directory} to the search path.
1481 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1482 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1483
1484 @kindex show paths
1485 @item show paths
1486 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1487 environment variable).
1488
1489 @kindex show environment
1490 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1491 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1492 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1493 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1494 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1495
1496 @kindex set environment
1497 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1498 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1499 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1500 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1501 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1502 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1503 null value.
1504 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1505 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1506
1507 For example, this command:
1508
1509 @example
1510 set env USER = foo
1511 @end example
1512
1513 @noindent
1514 tells a Unix program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1515 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1516 are not actually required.)
1517
1518 @kindex unset environment
1519 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1520 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1521 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1522 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1523 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1524 @end table
1525
1526 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} runs your program using the shell indicated
1527 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1528 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1529 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1530 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1531 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1532 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1533 @file{.profile}.
1534
1535 @node Working Directory
1536 @section Your program's working directory
1537
1538 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1539 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1540 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1541 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1542 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1543 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1544
1545 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1546 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1547 specify files}.
1548
1549 @table @code
1550 @kindex cd
1551 @item cd @var{directory}
1552 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1553
1554 @kindex pwd
1555 @item pwd
1556 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1557 @end table
1558
1559 @node Input/Output
1560 @section Your program's input and output
1561
1562 @cindex redirection
1563 @cindex i/o
1564 @cindex terminal
1565 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1566 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1567 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1568 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1569 running your program.
1570
1571 @table @code
1572 @kindex info terminal
1573 @item info terminal
1574 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1575 program is using.
1576 @end table
1577
1578 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1579 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1580
1581 @example
1582 run > outfile
1583 @end example
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1587
1588 @kindex tty
1589 @cindex controlling terminal
1590 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1591 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1592 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1593 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1594 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1595
1596 @example
1597 tty /dev/ttyb
1598 @end example
1599
1600 @noindent
1601 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1602 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1603 that as their controlling terminal.
1604
1605 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1606 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1607 terminal.
1608
1609 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1610 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1611 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1612
1613 @node Attach
1614 @section Debugging an already-running process
1615 @kindex attach
1616 @cindex attach
1617
1618 @table @code
1619 @item attach @var{process-id}
1620 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1621 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1622 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1623 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1624 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1625
1626 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1627 executing the command.
1628 @end table
1629
1630 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1631 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1632 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1633 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1634
1635 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1636 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1637 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1638 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1639 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1640 Specify Files}.
1641
1642 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1643 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1644 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1645 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1646 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1647 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1648 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1649
1650 @table @code
1651 @kindex detach
1652 @item detach
1653 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1654 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1655 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1656 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1657 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1658 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1659 executing the command.
1660 @end table
1661
1662 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1663 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1664 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1665 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1666 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1667 messages}).
1668
1669 @node Kill Process
1670 @section Killing the child process
1671
1672 @table @code
1673 @kindex kill
1674 @item kill
1675 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1676 @end table
1677
1678 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1679 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1680 is running.
1681
1682 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1683 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1684 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1685 outside the debugger.
1686
1687 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1688 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1689 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1690 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1691 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1692 breakpoint settings).
1693
1694 @node Threads
1695 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
1696
1697 @cindex threads of execution
1698 @cindex multiple threads
1699 @cindex switching threads
1700 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1701 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1702 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1703 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1704 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1705 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1706 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1707
1708 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1709 programs:
1710
1711 @itemize @bullet
1712 @item automatic notification of new threads
1713 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1714 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1715 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1716 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1717 @item thread-specific breakpoints
1718 @end itemize
1719
1720 @quotation
1721 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1722 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1723 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1724 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1725 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1726 like this:
1727
1728 @smallexample
1729 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
1730 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1731 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1732 see the IDs of currently known threads.
1733 @end smallexample
1734 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1735 @c doesn't support threads"?
1736 @end quotation
1737
1738 @cindex focus of debugging
1739 @cindex current thread
1740 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1741 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1742 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1743 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1744 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1745
1746 @kindex New @var{systag}
1747 @cindex thread identifier (system)
1748 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1749 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1750 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1751 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1752 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1753 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1754 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1755 LynxOS, you might see
1756
1757 @example
1758 [New process 35 thread 27]
1759 @end example
1760
1761 @noindent
1762 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1763 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1764 further qualifier.
1765
1766 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1767 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1768 @c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1769 @c program?
1770 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1771 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1772 @c threads ab initio?
1773
1774 @cindex thread number
1775 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1776 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1777 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1778
1779 @table @code
1780 @kindex info threads
1781 @item info threads
1782 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1783 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1784
1785 @enumerate
1786 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1787
1788 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1789
1790 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1791 @end enumerate
1792
1793 @noindent
1794 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1795 indicates the current thread.
1796
1797 For example,
1798 @end table
1799 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
1800
1801 @smallexample
1802 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
1803 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1804 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1805 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
1806 at threadtest.c:68
1807 @end smallexample
1808
1809 On HP-UX systems:
1810
1811 @cindex thread number
1812 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1813 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1814 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
1815 thread in your program.
1816
1817 @kindex New @var{systag}
1818 @cindex thread identifier (system)
1819 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1820 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1821 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1822 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1823 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1824 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1825 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1826 HP-UX, you see
1827
1828 @example
1829 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
1830 @end example
1831
1832 @noindent
1833 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
1834
1835 @table @code
1836 @kindex info threads
1837 @item info threads
1838 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1839 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1840
1841 @enumerate
1842 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1843
1844 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1845
1846 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1847 @end enumerate
1848
1849 @noindent
1850 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1851 indicates the current thread.
1852
1853 For example,
1854 @end table
1855 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
1856
1857 @example
1858 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
1859 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") at quicksort.c:137
1860 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () from /usr/lib/libc.2
1861 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () from /usr/lib/libc.2
1862 @end example
1863
1864 @table @code
1865 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
1866 @item thread @var{threadno}
1867 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
1868 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
1869 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
1870 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
1871 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
1872
1873 @smallexample
1874 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
1875 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
1876 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
1877 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1878 @end smallexample
1879
1880 @noindent
1881 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
1882 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
1883 threads.
1884
1885 @kindex thread apply
1886 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
1887 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
1888 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
1889 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
1890 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
1891 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
1892 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
1893 @end table
1894
1895 @cindex automatic thread selection
1896 @cindex switching threads automatically
1897 @cindex threads, automatic switching
1898 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
1899 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
1900 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
1901 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
1902 thread.
1903
1904 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
1905 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
1906 programs with multiple threads.
1907
1908 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
1909 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
1910
1911 @node Processes
1912 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
1913
1914 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
1915 @cindex multiple processes
1916 @cindex processes, multiple
1917 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
1918 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
1919 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
1920 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
1921 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
1922 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
1923 will cause it to terminate.
1924
1925 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
1926 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
1927 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
1928 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
1929 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
1930 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
1931 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
1932 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
1933 the child process (see @ref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
1934 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
1935
1936 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
1937 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
1938 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
1939
1940 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
1941 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
1942
1943 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
1944 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
1945
1946 @table @code
1947 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
1948 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
1949 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
1950 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
1951 process. The @var{mode} can be:
1952
1953 @table @code
1954 @item parent
1955 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
1956 unimpeded.
1957
1958 @item child
1959 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
1960 unimpeded.
1961
1962 @item ask
1963 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
1964 @end table
1965
1966 @item show follow-fork-mode
1967 Display the current debugger response to a fork or vfork call.
1968 @end table
1969
1970 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
1971 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
1972 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
1973 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
1974 the child process's @code{main}.
1975
1976 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
1977 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
1978
1979 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
1980 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
1981 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
1982 argument.
1983
1984 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
1985 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
1986 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
1987
1988 @node Stopping
1989 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
1990
1991 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
1992 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
1993 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
1994
1995 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
1996 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
1997 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
1998 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
1999 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2000 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2001 explicitly request this information at any time.
2002
2003 @table @code
2004 @kindex info program
2005 @item info program
2006 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2007 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2008 @end table
2009
2010 @menu
2011 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2012 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2013 * Signals:: Signals
2014 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2015 @end menu
2016
2017 @node Breakpoints
2018 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2019
2020 @cindex breakpoints
2021 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2022 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2023 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2024 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2025 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2026 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2027 program.
2028
2029 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2030 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2031 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2032 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2033 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2034 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2035
2036 @cindex watchpoints
2037 @cindex memory tracing
2038 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2039 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2040 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2041 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2042 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2043 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2044 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2045 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2046
2047 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2048 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2049 Automatic display}.
2050
2051 @cindex catchpoints
2052 @cindex breakpoint on events
2053 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2054 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2055 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2056 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2057 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2058 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2059 @code{handle} command; @pxref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2060
2061 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2062 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2063 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2064 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2065 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2066 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2067 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2068 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2069 enable it again.
2070
2071 @menu
2072 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2073 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2074 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2075 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2076 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2077 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2078 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2079 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2080
2081 @c * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2082 @end menu
2083
2084 @node Set Breaks
2085 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2086
2087 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2088 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2089 @c
2090 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2091
2092 @kindex break
2093 @kindex b
2094 @kindex $bpnum
2095 @cindex latest breakpoint
2096 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2097 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2098 number of the breakpoints you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2099 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2100 convenience variables.
2101
2102 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2103
2104 @table @code
2105 @item break @var{function}
2106 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2107 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2108 C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2109 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2110
2111 @item break +@var{offset}
2112 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2113 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2114 at which execution stopped in the currently selected frame.
2115
2116 @item break @var{linenum}
2117 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2118 That file is the last file whose source text was printed. This
2119 breakpoint stops your program just before it executes any of the
2120 code on that line.
2121
2122 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2123 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2124
2125 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2126 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2127 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2128 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2129 functions.
2130
2131 @item break *@var{address}
2132 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2133 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2134 information or source files.
2135
2136 @item break
2137 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2138 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2139 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2140 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2141 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2142 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2143 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2144 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2145 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2146 inside loops.
2147
2148 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2149 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2150 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2151 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2152 existed when your program stopped.
2153
2154 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2155 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2156 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2157 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2158 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2159 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2160 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2161
2162 @kindex tbreak
2163 @item tbreak @var{args}
2164 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2165 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2166 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2167 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2168
2169 @kindex hbreak
2170 @item hbreak @var{args}
2171 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2172 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2173 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2174 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2175 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2176 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2177 provided by SPARClite DSU. DSU will generate traps when a program accesses
2178 some data or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers.
2179 However the hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data breakpoints,
2180 and @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used.
2181 Delete or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting
2182 new ones. @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2183
2184 @kindex thbreak
2185 @item thbreak @var{args}
2186 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2187 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2188 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2189 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2190 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2191 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2192 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2193 Also @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2194
2195 @kindex rbreak
2196 @cindex regular expression
2197 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2198 @c FIXME what kind of regexp?
2199 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2200 @var{regex}. This command
2201 sets an unconditional breakpoint on all matches, printing a list of all
2202 breakpoints it set. Once these breakpoints are set, they are treated
2203 just like the breakpoints set with the @code{break} command. You can
2204 delete them, disable them, or make them conditional the same way as any
2205 other breakpoint.
2206
2207 When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2208 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2209 classes.
2210
2211 @kindex info breakpoints
2212 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2213 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2214 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2215 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2216 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2217 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2218
2219 @table @emph
2220 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2221 @item Type
2222 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2223 @item Disposition
2224 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2225 @item Enabled or Disabled
2226 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2227 that are not enabled.
2228 @item Address
2229 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address
2230 @item What
2231 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2232 line number.
2233 @end table
2234
2235 @noindent
2236 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2237 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2238 are listed after that.
2239
2240 @noindent
2241 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2242 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2243 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2244 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2245 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2246
2247 @noindent
2248 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2249 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2250 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2251 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2252 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2253 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2254 @end table
2255
2256 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2257 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2258 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2259 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2260
2261 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2262 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2263 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2264 purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2265 These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2266 @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2267
2268 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2269 @samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2270
2271 @table @code
2272 @kindex maint info breakpoints
2273 @item maint info breakpoints
2274 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2275 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2276 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2277 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2278 is shown:
2279
2280 @table @code
2281 @item breakpoint
2282 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2283
2284 @item watchpoint
2285 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2286
2287 @item longjmp
2288 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2289 @code{longjmp} calls.
2290
2291 @item longjmp resume
2292 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2293
2294 @item until
2295 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2296
2297 @item finish
2298 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2299
2300 @item shlib events
2301 Shared library events.
2302
2303 @end table
2304
2305 @end table
2306
2307
2308 @node Set Watchpoints
2309 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2310
2311 @cindex setting watchpoints
2312 @cindex software watchpoints
2313 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2314 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2315 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2316 this may happen.
2317
2318 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2319 hardware. GDB does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2320 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2321 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2322 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2323 culprit.)
2324
2325 On some systems, such as HP-UX and Linux, GDB includes support for
2326 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2327 program.
2328
2329 @table @code
2330 @kindex watch
2331 @item watch @var{expr}
2332 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2333 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2334
2335 @kindex rwatch
2336 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2337 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2338
2339 @kindex awatch
2340 @item awatch @var{expr}
2341 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{args} is read and written into
2342 by the program.
2343
2344 @kindex info watchpoints
2345 @item info watchpoints
2346 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2347 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2348 @end table
2349
2350 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2351 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2352 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2353 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2354 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2355 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2356
2357 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2358
2359 @example
2360 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2361 @end example
2362
2363 @noindent
2364 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2365
2366 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2367 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2368 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2369 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2370 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2371 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2372 will print a message like this:
2373
2374 @smallexample
2375 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2376 @end smallexample
2377
2378 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2379 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2380 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2381 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2382 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2383 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2384 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2385 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2386
2387 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2388 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2389 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2390 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2391 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2392 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2393
2394 @smallexample
2395 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2396 @end smallexample
2397
2398 @noindent
2399 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2400
2401 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2402 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2403 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2404 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2405 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2406 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2407 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2408 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2409 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2410 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2411
2412 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2413 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until GDB reaches another
2414 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2415
2416 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2417 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2418 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2419 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2420 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2421 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2422 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2423 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2424 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2425
2426 @quotation
2427 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2428 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2429 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2430 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2431 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2432 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2433 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2434 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2435 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2436 the expression.
2437
2438 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2439 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2440 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2441 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2442 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2443 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2444 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2445 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2446 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2447 @end quotation
2448
2449 @node Set Catchpoints
2450 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2451 @cindex catchpoints
2452 @cindex exception handlers
2453 @cindex event handling
2454
2455 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2456 kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2457 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2458
2459 @table @code
2460 @kindex catch
2461 @item catch @var{event}
2462 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2463 @table @code
2464 @item throw
2465 @kindex catch throw
2466 The throwing of a C++ exception.
2467
2468 @item catch
2469 @kindex catch catch
2470 The catching of a C++ exception.
2471
2472 @item exec
2473 @kindex catch exec
2474 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2475
2476 @item fork
2477 @kindex catch fork
2478 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2479
2480 @item vfork
2481 @kindex catch vfork
2482 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2483
2484 @item load
2485 @itemx load @var{libname}
2486 @kindex catch load
2487 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2488 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2489
2490 @item unload
2491 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2492 @kindex catch unload
2493 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2494 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2495 @end table
2496
2497 @item tcatch @var{event}
2498 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2499 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2500
2501 @end table
2502
2503 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2504
2505 There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2506 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2507
2508 @itemize @bullet
2509 @item
2510 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2511 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2512 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2513 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2514 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2515 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2516 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2517 disabled within interactive calls.
2518
2519 @item
2520 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2521
2522 @item
2523 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2524 @end itemize
2525
2526 @cindex raise exceptions
2527 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2528 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2529 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2530 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2531 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2532 out where the exception was raised.
2533
2534 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2535 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2536 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2537 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2538
2539 @example
2540 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2541 ID is the exception identifier. */
2542 void __raise_exception (void **@var{addr}, void *@var{id});
2543 @end example
2544
2545 @noindent
2546 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2547 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2548 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2549
2550 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2551 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2552 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2553 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2554 raised.
2555
2556
2557 @node Delete Breaks
2558 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2559
2560 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2561 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2562 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2563 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2564 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2565 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2566
2567 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2568 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2569 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2570 their breakpoint numbers.
2571
2572 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2573 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2574 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2575
2576 @table @code
2577 @kindex clear
2578 @item clear
2579 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2580 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2581 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2582 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2583
2584 @item clear @var{function}
2585 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2586 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2587
2588 @item clear @var{linenum}
2589 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2590 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2591
2592 @cindex delete breakpoints
2593 @kindex delete
2594 @kindex d
2595 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2596 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the numbers
2597 specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2598 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2599 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2600 @end table
2601
2602 @node Disabling
2603 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2604
2605 @kindex disable breakpoints
2606 @kindex enable breakpoints
2607 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2608 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2609 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2610 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2611
2612 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2613 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2614 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2615 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2616 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2617
2618 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2619 states of enablement:
2620
2621 @itemize @bullet
2622 @item
2623 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2624 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2625 @item
2626 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2627 @item
2628 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2629 disabled. A breakpoint set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in
2630 this state.
2631 @item
2632 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2633 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently.
2634 @end itemize
2635
2636 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2637 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2638
2639 @table @code
2640 @kindex disable breakpoints
2641 @kindex disable
2642 @kindex dis
2643 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2644 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2645 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2646 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2647 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2648 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2649
2650 @kindex enable breakpoints
2651 @kindex enable
2652 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2653 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2654 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2655
2656 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{bnums}@dots{}
2657 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2658 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2659
2660 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{bnums}@dots{}
2661 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2662 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2663 @end table
2664
2665 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2666 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2667 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2668 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2669 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2670 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2671 stepping}.)
2672
2673 @node Conditions
2674 @subsection Break conditions
2675 @cindex conditional breakpoints
2676 @cindex breakpoint conditions
2677
2678 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2679 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
2680 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2681 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2682 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2683 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2684 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2685 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2686
2687 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2688 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2689 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2690 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2691 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2692
2693 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2694 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2695 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2696 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2697 one.
2698
2699 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2700 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2701 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2702 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2703 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2704 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2705 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
2706 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible for the
2707 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2708 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2709
2710 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2711 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2712 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2713 with the @code{condition} command.
2714
2715 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2716 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2717 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2718 catchpoint.
2719
2720 @table @code
2721 @kindex condition
2722 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2723 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2724 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2725 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2726 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2727 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2728 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
2729 referents in the context of your breakpoint.
2730 @c FIXME so what does GDB do if there is no referent? Moreover, what
2731 @c about watchpoints?
2732 @value{GDBN} does
2733 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
2734 command is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
2735
2736 @item condition @var{bnum}
2737 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2738 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2739 @end table
2740
2741 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2742 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2743 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2744 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2745 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2746 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2747 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2748 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2749 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2750 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
2751 your program reaches it.
2752
2753 @table @code
2754 @kindex ignore
2755 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
2756 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
2757 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
2758 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
2759 takes no action.
2760
2761 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
2762 a count of zero.
2763
2764 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
2765 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
2766 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
2767 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
2768
2769 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
2770 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
2771 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
2772
2773 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
2774 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
2775 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
2776 variables}.
2777 @end table
2778
2779 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
2780
2781
2782 @node Break Commands
2783 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
2784
2785 @cindex breakpoint commands
2786 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
2787 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
2788 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
2789 enable other breakpoints.
2790
2791 @table @code
2792 @kindex commands
2793 @kindex end
2794 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
2795 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
2796 @itemx end
2797 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
2798 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
2799 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
2800
2801 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
2802 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
2803
2804 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
2805 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
2806 recently encountered).
2807 @end table
2808
2809 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
2810 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
2811
2812 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
2813 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
2814 that resumes execution.
2815
2816 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
2817 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
2818 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
2819 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
2820 ambiguities about which list to execute.
2821
2822 @kindex silent
2823 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
2824 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
2825 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
2826 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
2827 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
2828 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
2829
2830 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
2831 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
2832 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
2833
2834 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
2835 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
2836
2837 @example
2838 break foo if x>0
2839 commands
2840 silent
2841 printf "x is %d\n",x
2842 cont
2843 end
2844 @end example
2845
2846 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
2847 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
2848 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
2849 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
2850 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
2851 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
2852 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
2853
2854 @example
2855 break 403
2856 commands
2857 silent
2858 set x = y + 4
2859 cont
2860 end
2861 @end example
2862
2863 @node Breakpoint Menus
2864 @subsection Breakpoint menus
2865 @cindex overloading
2866 @cindex symbol overloading
2867
2868 Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
2869 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
2870 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
2871 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
2872 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
2873 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
2874 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
2875 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
2876 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
2877 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
2878 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
2879 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
2880 breakpoints.
2881
2882 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
2883 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
2884 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
2885
2886 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
2887 @smallexample
2888 @group
2889 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
2890 [0] cancel
2891 [1] all
2892 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
2893 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
2894 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
2895 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
2896 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
2897 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
2898 > 2 4 6
2899 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
2900 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
2901 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
2902 Multiple breakpoints were set.
2903 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
2904 breakpoints.
2905 (@value{GDBP})
2906 @end group
2907 @end smallexample
2908
2909 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
2910 @c @node Error in Breakpoints
2911 @c @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2912 @c
2913 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
2914 @c
2915 @c Under some operating systems
2916 @c any other process is running that program. In this situation,
2917 @c attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
2918 @c @value{GDBN} to stop the other process.
2919 @c
2920 @c When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
2921 @c
2922 @c @enumerate
2923 @c @item
2924 @c Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
2925 @c
2926 @c @item
2927 @c Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
2928 @c name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
2929 @c that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
2930 @c Then start your program again.
2931 @c
2932 @c @item
2933 @c Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
2934 @c linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
2935 @c to nonsharable executables.
2936 @c @end enumerate
2937 @c @end ifclear
2938
2939 @node Continuing and Stepping
2940 @section Continuing and stepping
2941
2942 @cindex stepping
2943 @cindex continuing
2944 @cindex resuming execution
2945 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
2946 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
2947 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
2948 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
2949 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
2950 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
2951 due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use @samp{signal
2952 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2953
2954 @table @code
2955 @kindex continue
2956 @kindex c
2957 @kindex fg
2958 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
2959 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
2960 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
2961 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
2962 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
2963 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
2964 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
2965 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2966
2967 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
2968 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
2969 @code{continue} is ignored.
2970
2971 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} are provided purely for convenience,
2972 and have exactly the same behavior as @code{continue}.
2973 @end table
2974
2975 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
2976 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
2977 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
2978 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
2979
2980 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
2981 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
2982 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
2983 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
2984 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
2985 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
2986
2987 @table @code
2988 @kindex step
2989 @kindex s
2990 @item step
2991 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
2992 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
2993 abbreviated @code{s}.
2994
2995 @quotation
2996 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
2997 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
2998 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
2999 @c distinction here.
3000 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3001 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3002 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3003 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3004 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3005 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3006 below.
3007 @end quotation
3008
3009 The @code{step} command now only stops at the first instruction of a
3010 source line. This prevents the multiple stops that used to occur in
3011 switch statements, for loops, etc. @code{step} continues to stop if a
3012 function that has debugging information is called within the line.
3013
3014 Also, the @code{step} command now only enters a subroutine if there is line
3015 number information for the subroutine. Otherwise it acts like the
3016 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3017 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3018 was any debugging information about the routine.
3019
3020 @item step @var{count}
3021 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3022 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3023 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3024
3025 @kindex next
3026 @kindex n
3027 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3028 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3029 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3030 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3031 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3032 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3033 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3034
3035 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3036
3037
3038 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3039 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3040 @c
3041 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3042 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3043 @c function are executed without stopping.
3044
3045 The @code{next} command now only stops at the first instruction of a
3046 source line. This prevents the multiple stops that used to occur in
3047 switch statements, for loops, etc.
3048
3049 @kindex finish
3050 @item finish
3051 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3052 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3053
3054 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3055 ,Returning from a function}).
3056
3057 @kindex until
3058 @kindex u
3059 @item until
3060 @itemx u
3061 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3062 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3063 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3064 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3065 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3066 than the address of the jump.
3067
3068 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3069 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3070 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3071 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3072 through the next iteration.
3073
3074 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3075 stack frame.
3076
3077 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3078 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3079 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3080 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3081 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3082
3083 @example
3084 (@value{GDBP}) f
3085 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3086 206 expand_input();
3087 (@value{GDBP}) until
3088 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3089 @end example
3090
3091 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3092 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3093 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3094 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3095 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3096 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3097 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3098
3099 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3100 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3101 argument.
3102
3103 @item until @var{location}
3104 @itemx u @var{location}
3105 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3106 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3107 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3108 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3109 and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3110
3111 @kindex stepi
3112 @kindex si
3113 @item stepi
3114 @itemx si
3115 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3116
3117 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3118 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3119 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3120 Display,, Automatic display}.
3121
3122 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3123
3124 @need 750
3125 @kindex nexti
3126 @kindex ni
3127 @item nexti
3128 @itemx ni
3129 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3130 proceed until the function returns.
3131
3132 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3133 @end table
3134
3135 @node Signals
3136 @section Signals
3137 @cindex signals
3138
3139 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3140 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3141 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3142 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt (often @kbd{C-c});
3143 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3144 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3145 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3146 requested an alarm).
3147
3148 @cindex fatal signals
3149 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3150 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3151 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (kill your program immediately) if the
3152 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3153 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3154 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3155
3156 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3157 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3158 signal.
3159
3160 @cindex handling signals
3161 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3162 (so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3163 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3164 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3165
3166 @table @code
3167 @kindex info signals
3168 @item info signals
3169 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3170 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3171 the defined types of signals.
3172
3173 @code{info handle} is the new alias for @code{info signals}.
3174
3175 @kindex handle
3176 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3177 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
3178 be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3179 beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3180 @end table
3181
3182 @c @group
3183 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3184 Their full names are:
3185
3186 @table @code
3187 @item nostop
3188 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3189 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3190
3191 @item stop
3192 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3193 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3194
3195 @item print
3196 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3197
3198 @item noprint
3199 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3200 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3201
3202 @item pass
3203 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3204 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3205 and not handled.
3206
3207 @item nopass
3208 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3209 @end table
3210 @c @end group
3211
3212 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible until you
3213 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3214 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3215 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3216 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3217 program sees that signal when you continue.
3218
3219 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3220 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3221 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3222 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3223 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3224 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3225 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3226 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3227 program a signal}.
3228
3229 @node Thread Stops
3230 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3231
3232 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3233 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3234 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3235
3236 @table @code
3237 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3238 @cindex thread breakpoints
3239 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3240 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3241 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3242 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3243 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3244
3245 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3246 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3247 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3248 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3249 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3250
3251 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3252 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3253 program.
3254
3255 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3256 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3257 breakpoint condition, like this:
3258
3259 @smallexample
3260 (gdb) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3261 @end smallexample
3262
3263 @end table
3264
3265 @cindex stopped threads
3266 @cindex threads, stopped
3267 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3268 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3269 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3270 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3271 underfoot.
3272
3273 @cindex continuing threads
3274 @cindex threads, continuing
3275 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3276 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3277 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3278
3279 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3280 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3281 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3282 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3283 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3284 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3285 stops.
3286
3287 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3288 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3289 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3290 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3291
3292 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3293 thread to run.
3294
3295 @table @code
3296 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3297 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3298 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3299 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3300 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3301 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3302 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3303 when you step. They are more likely to run when you ``next'' over a
3304 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3305 like ``continue'', ``until'', or ``finish''. However, unless another
3306 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3307 GDB prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3308
3309 @item show scheduler-locking
3310 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3311 @end table
3312
3313
3314 @node Stack
3315 @chapter Examining the Stack
3316
3317 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3318 stopped and how it got there.
3319
3320 @cindex call stack
3321 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3322 is generated.
3323 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3324 the arguments of the call,
3325 and the local variables of the function being called.
3326 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3327 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3328 stack}.
3329
3330 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3331 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3332
3333 @cindex selected frame
3334 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3335 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3336 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3337 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3338 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3339 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3340
3341 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3342 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3343 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3344
3345 @menu
3346 * Frames:: Stack frames
3347 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3348 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3349 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3350
3351 @end menu
3352
3353 @node Frames
3354 @section Stack frames
3355
3356 @cindex frame
3357 @cindex stack frame
3358 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3359 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3360 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3361 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3362 which the function is executing.
3363
3364 @cindex initial frame
3365 @cindex outermost frame
3366 @cindex innermost frame
3367 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3368 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3369 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3370 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3371 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3372 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3373 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3374 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3375
3376 @cindex frame pointer
3377 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3378 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3379 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3380 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3381 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3382 going on in that frame.
3383
3384 @cindex frame number
3385 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3386 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3387 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3388 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3389 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3390
3391 @c below produces an acceptable overful hbox. --mew 13aug1993
3392 @cindex frameless execution
3393 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3394 without stack frames. (For example, the @code{@value{GCC}} option
3395 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} generates functions without a frame.)
3396 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3397 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3398 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3399 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3400 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3401 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3402 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3403
3404 @table @code
3405 @kindex frame
3406 @item frame @var{args}
3407 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3408 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3409 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3410 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3411
3412 @kindex select-frame
3413 @item select-frame
3414 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3415 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3416 @code{frame}.
3417 @end table
3418
3419 @node Backtrace
3420 @section Backtraces
3421
3422 @cindex backtraces
3423 @cindex tracebacks
3424 @cindex stack traces
3425 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3426 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3427 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3428 stack.
3429
3430 @table @code
3431 @kindex backtrace
3432 @kindex bt
3433 @item backtrace
3434 @itemx bt
3435 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3436 frames in the stack.
3437
3438 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3439 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3440
3441 @item backtrace @var{n}
3442 @itemx bt @var{n}
3443 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3444
3445 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3446 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3447 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3448 @end table
3449
3450 @kindex where
3451 @kindex info stack
3452 @kindex info s
3453 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3454 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3455
3456 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3457 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3458 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3459 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3460 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3461 line number.
3462
3463 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3464 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3465
3466 @smallexample
3467 @group
3468 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3469 at builtin.c:993
3470 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3471 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3472 at macro.c:71
3473 (More stack frames follow...)
3474 @end group
3475 @end smallexample
3476
3477 @noindent
3478 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3479 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3480 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3481
3482 @node Selection
3483 @section Selecting a frame
3484
3485 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3486 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3487 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3488 of the stack frame just selected.
3489
3490 @table @code
3491 @kindex frame
3492 @kindex f
3493 @item frame @var{n}
3494 @itemx f @var{n}
3495 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3496 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3497 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3498 @code{main}.
3499
3500 @item frame @var{addr}
3501 @itemx f @var{addr}
3502 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3503 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3504 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3505 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3506 switches between them.
3507
3508 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3509 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3510
3511 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3512 pointer and a program counter.
3513
3514 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3515 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3516 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3517 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3518 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3519
3520 @kindex up
3521 @item up @var{n}
3522 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3523 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3524 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3525
3526 @kindex down
3527 @kindex do
3528 @item down @var{n}
3529 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3530 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3531 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3532 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3533 @end table
3534
3535 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3536 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3537 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3538 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3539
3540 @need 1000
3541 For example:
3542
3543 @smallexample
3544 @group
3545 (@value{GDBP}) up
3546 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3547 at env.c:10
3548 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3549 @end group
3550 @end smallexample
3551
3552 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3553 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3554 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3555
3556 @table @code
3557 @kindex down-silently
3558 @kindex up-silently
3559 @item up-silently @var{n}
3560 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
3561 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3562 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3563 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3564 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3565 distracting.
3566 @end table
3567
3568 @node Frame Info
3569 @section Information about a frame
3570
3571 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3572 stack frame.
3573
3574 @table @code
3575 @item frame
3576 @itemx f
3577 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3578 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3579 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3580 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3581 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3582
3583 @kindex info frame
3584 @kindex info f
3585 @item info frame
3586 @itemx info f
3587 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3588 including:
3589
3590 @itemize @bullet
3591 @item
3592 the address of the frame
3593 @item
3594 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3595 @item
3596 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3597 @item
3598 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3599 @item
3600 the address of the frame's arguments
3601 @item
3602 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3603 @item
3604 which registers were saved in the frame
3605 @end itemize
3606
3607 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
3608 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3609 the usual conventions.
3610
3611 @item info frame @var{addr}
3612 @itemx info f @var{addr}
3613 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3614 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3615 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3616 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3617 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3618
3619 @kindex info args
3620 @item info args
3621 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3622
3623 @item info locals
3624 @kindex info locals
3625 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3626 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3627 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3628
3629 @kindex info catch
3630 @cindex catch exceptions
3631 @cindex exception handlers
3632 @item info catch
3633 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3634 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3635 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3636 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3637 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
3638
3639 @end table
3640
3641
3642 @node Source
3643 @chapter Examining Source Files
3644
3645 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3646 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3647 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3648 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3649 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3650 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3651 source files by explicit command.
3652
3653 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
3654 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
3655 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
3656
3657 @menu
3658 * List:: Printing source lines
3659 * Search:: Searching source files
3660 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3661 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3662 @end menu
3663
3664 @node List
3665 @section Printing source lines
3666
3667 @kindex list
3668 @kindex l
3669 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3670 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
3671 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3672
3673 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3674
3675 @table @code
3676 @item list @var{linenum}
3677 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3678 current source file.
3679
3680 @item list @var{function}
3681 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3682 @var{function}.
3683
3684 @item list
3685 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3686 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3687 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3688 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3689 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3690
3691 @item list -
3692 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3693 @end table
3694
3695 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
3696 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
3697
3698 @table @code
3699 @kindex set listsize
3700 @item set listsize @var{count}
3701 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
3702 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
3703
3704 @kindex show listsize
3705 @item show listsize
3706 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
3707 @end table
3708
3709 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
3710 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
3711 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
3712 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
3713 each repetition moves up in the source file.
3714
3715 @cindex linespec
3716 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
3717 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
3718 of writing them but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3719 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
3720
3721 @table @code
3722 @item list @var{linespec}
3723 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
3724
3725 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
3726 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
3727 linespecs.
3728
3729 @item list ,@var{last}
3730 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
3731
3732 @item list @var{first},
3733 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
3734
3735 @item list +
3736 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
3737
3738 @item list -
3739 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3740
3741 @item list
3742 As described in the preceding table.
3743 @end table
3744
3745 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
3746 kinds of linespec.
3747
3748 @table @code
3749 @item @var{number}
3750 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
3751 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
3752 the same source file as the first linespec.
3753
3754 @item +@var{offset}
3755 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
3756 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
3757 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
3758 first linespec.
3759
3760 @item -@var{offset}
3761 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
3762
3763 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
3764 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
3765
3766 @item @var{function}
3767 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
3768 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
3769
3770 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
3771 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
3772 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
3773 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
3774 identically named functions in different source files.
3775
3776 @item *@var{address}
3777 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
3778 @var{address} may be any expression.
3779 @end table
3780
3781 @node Search
3782 @section Searching source files
3783 @cindex searching
3784 @kindex reverse-search
3785
3786 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
3787 regular expression.
3788
3789 @table @code
3790 @kindex search
3791 @kindex forward-search
3792 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
3793 @itemx search @var{regexp}
3794 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
3795 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
3796 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
3797 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
3798 @code{fo}.
3799
3800 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
3801 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
3802 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
3803 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
3804 this command as @code{rev}.
3805 @end table
3806
3807 @node Source Path
3808 @section Specifying source directories
3809
3810 @cindex source path
3811 @cindex directories for source files
3812 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
3813 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
3814 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
3815 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
3816 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
3817 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
3818 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
3819 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
3820 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
3821 path.
3822
3823 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
3824 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
3825 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
3826 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
3827 last resort.
3828
3829 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
3830 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
3831 each line is in the file.
3832
3833 @kindex directory
3834 @kindex dir
3835 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path is empty.
3836 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
3837
3838 @table @code
3839 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
3840 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
3841 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
3842 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:} or
3843 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
3844 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
3845
3846 @kindex cdir
3847 @kindex cwd
3848 @kindex $cdir
3849 @kindex $cwd
3850 @cindex compilation directory
3851 @cindex current directory
3852 @cindex working directory
3853 @cindex directory, current
3854 @cindex directory, compilation
3855 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
3856 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
3857 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
3858 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
3859 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
3860 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
3861
3862 @item directory
3863 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
3864
3865 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
3866 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
3867
3868 @item show directories
3869 @kindex show directories
3870 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
3871 @end table
3872
3873 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
3874 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
3875 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
3876
3877 @enumerate
3878 @item
3879 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
3880
3881 @item
3882 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
3883 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
3884 directories in one command.
3885 @end enumerate
3886
3887 @node Machine Code
3888 @section Source and machine code
3889
3890 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
3891 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
3892 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
3893 mode, the @code{info line} command now causes the arrow to point to the
3894 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
3895 well as hex.
3896
3897 @table @code
3898 @kindex info line
3899 @item info line @var{linespec}
3900 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
3901 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
3902 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
3903 source lines}).
3904 @end table
3905
3906 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
3907 the object code for the first line of function
3908 @code{m4_changequote}:
3909
3910 @smallexample
3911 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changecom
3912 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
3913 @end smallexample
3914
3915 @noindent
3916 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
3917 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
3918 @smallexample
3919 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
3920 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
3921 @end smallexample
3922
3923 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
3924 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
3925 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
3926 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
3927 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
3928 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3929 variables}).
3930
3931 @table @code
3932 @kindex disassemble
3933 @cindex assembly instructions
3934 @cindex instructions, assembly
3935 @cindex machine instructions
3936 @cindex listing machine instructions
3937 @item disassemble
3938 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
3939 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
3940 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
3941 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
3942 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
3943 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
3944 @end table
3945
3946 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
3947 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
3948
3949 @smallexample
3950 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
3951 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
3952 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
3953 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
3954 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
3955 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
3956 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
3957 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
3958 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
3959 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
3960 End of assembler dump.
3961 @end smallexample
3962
3963 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
3964 mnemonics or other syntax.
3965
3966 @table @code
3967 @kindex set assembly-language
3968 @cindex assembly instructions
3969 @cindex instructions, assembly
3970 @cindex machine instructions
3971 @cindex listing machine instructions
3972 @item set assembly-language @var{instruction-set}
3973 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
3974 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
3975
3976 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
3977 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{i386} or @code{i8086}.
3978 The default is @code{i386}.
3979 @end table
3980
3981
3982 @node Data
3983 @chapter Examining Data
3984
3985 @cindex printing data
3986 @cindex examining data
3987 @kindex print
3988 @kindex inspect
3989 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
3990 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
3991 @c different window or something like that.
3992 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
3993 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
3994 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
3995 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
3996 Different Languages}).
3997
3998 @table @code
3999 @item print @var{exp}
4000 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{exp}
4001 @var{exp} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4002 value of @var{exp} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4003 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4004 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; @pxref{Output Formats,,Output
4005 formats}.
4006
4007 @item print
4008 @itemx print /@var{f}
4009 If you omit @var{exp}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4010 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4011 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4012 @end table
4013
4014 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4015 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4016 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4017
4018 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4019 fields of a struct or class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4020 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4021 Table}.
4022
4023 @menu
4024 * Expressions:: Expressions
4025 * Variables:: Program variables
4026 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4027 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4028 * Memory:: Examining memory
4029 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4030 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4031 * Value History:: Value history
4032 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4033 * Registers:: Registers
4034 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4035 @end menu
4036
4037 @node Expressions
4038 @section Expressions
4039
4040 @cindex expressions
4041 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4042 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4043 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4044 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4045 and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4046 by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4047
4048 @value{GDBN} now supports array constants in expressions input by
4049 the user. The syntax is @var{@{element, element@dots{}@}}. For example,
4050 you can now use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4051 memory that is malloc'd in the target program.
4052
4053 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4054 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4055 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4056 languages.
4057
4058 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4059 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4060
4061 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4062 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4063 at that address in memory.
4064 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4065
4066 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4067 to programming languages:
4068
4069 @table @code
4070 @item @@
4071 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4072 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4073
4074 @item ::
4075 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4076 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4077
4078 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4079 @cindex type casting memory
4080 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4081 @cindex casts, to view memory
4082 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4083 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4084 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4085 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4086 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4087 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4088 @end table
4089
4090 @node Variables
4091 @section Program variables
4092
4093 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4094 in your program.
4095
4096 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4097 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4098
4099 @itemize @bullet
4100 @item
4101 global (or file-static)
4102 @end itemize
4103
4104 @noindent or
4105
4106 @itemize @bullet
4107 @item
4108 visible according to the scope rules of the
4109 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4110 @end itemize
4111
4112 @noindent This means that in the function
4113
4114 @example
4115 foo (a)
4116 int a;
4117 @{
4118 bar (a);
4119 @{
4120 int b = test ();
4121 bar (b);
4122 @}
4123 @}
4124 @end example
4125
4126 @noindent
4127 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4128 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4129 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4130 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4131
4132 @cindex variable name conflict
4133 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4134 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4135 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4136 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4137 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4138 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4139 using the colon-colon notation:
4140
4141 @cindex colon-colon
4142 @iftex
4143 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4144 @kindex ::
4145 @end iftex
4146 @example
4147 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4148 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4149 @end example
4150
4151 @noindent
4152 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4153 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4154 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4155 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4156
4157 @example
4158 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4159 @end example
4160
4161 @cindex C++ scope resolution
4162 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4163 use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4164 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4165 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4166 @c conflict?? --mew
4167
4168 @cindex wrong values
4169 @cindex variable values, wrong
4170 @quotation
4171 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4172 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4173 scope, and just before exit.
4174 @end quotation
4175 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4176 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4177 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4178 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4179 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4180 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4181 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4182 variable definitions may be gone.
4183
4184 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4185 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4186 when compiling.
4187
4188 @node Arrays
4189 @section Artificial arrays
4190
4191 @cindex artificial array
4192 @kindex @@
4193 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4194 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4195 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4196 program.
4197
4198 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4199 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4200 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4201 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4202 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4203 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4204 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4205 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4206 example. If a program says
4207
4208 @example
4209 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4210 @end example
4211
4212 @noindent
4213 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4214
4215 @example
4216 p *array@@len
4217 @end example
4218
4219 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4220 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4221 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4222 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4223 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4224
4225 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4226 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4227 The value need not be in memory:
4228 @example
4229 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4230 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4231 @end example
4232
4233 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4234 @samp{(@var{type})[])@var{value}}) gdb calculates the size to fill
4235 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4236 @example
4237 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4238 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4239 @end example
4240
4241 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4242 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4243 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4244 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4245 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4246 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4247 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4248 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4249 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4250 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4251
4252 @example
4253 set $i = 0
4254 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4255 @key{RET}
4256 @key{RET}
4257 @dots{}
4258 @end example
4259
4260 @node Output Formats
4261 @section Output formats
4262
4263 @cindex formatted output
4264 @cindex output formats
4265 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4266 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4267 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4268 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4269 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4270
4271 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4272 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4273 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4274 letters supported are:
4275
4276 @table @code
4277 @item x
4278 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4279 hexadecimal.
4280
4281 @item d
4282 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4283
4284 @item u
4285 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4286
4287 @item o
4288 Print as integer in octal.
4289
4290 @item t
4291 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4292 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4293 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4294 @pxref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4295
4296 @item a
4297 @cindex unknown address, locating
4298 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4299 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4300 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4301
4302 @example
4303 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4304 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4305 @end example
4306
4307 @item c
4308 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4309
4310 @item f
4311 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4312 using typical floating point syntax.
4313 @end table
4314
4315 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4316
4317 @example
4318 p/x $pc
4319 @end example
4320
4321 @noindent
4322 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4323 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4324
4325 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4326 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4327 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4328
4329 @node Memory
4330 @section Examining memory
4331
4332 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4333 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4334
4335 @cindex examining memory
4336 @table @code
4337 @kindex x
4338 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4339 @itemx x @var{addr}
4340 @itemx x
4341 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4342 @end table
4343
4344 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4345 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4346 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4347 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4348 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4349
4350 @table @r
4351 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4352 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4353 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4354 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4355 @c 4.1.2.
4356
4357 @item @var{f}, the display format
4358 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4359 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4360 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4361 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4362
4363 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4364 The unit size is any of
4365
4366 @table @code
4367 @item b
4368 Bytes.
4369 @item h
4370 Halfwords (two bytes).
4371 @item w
4372 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4373 @item g
4374 Giant words (eight bytes).
4375 @end table
4376
4377 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4378 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4379 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4380
4381 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4382 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4383 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4384 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4385 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4386 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4387 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4388 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4389 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4390 a value from memory).
4391 @end table
4392
4393 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4394 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4395 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4396 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4397 @pxref{Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4398
4399 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4400 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4401 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4402 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4403 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4404
4405 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4406 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4407 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4408 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4409 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; @pxref{Machine
4410 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4411
4412 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4413 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4414 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4415 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4416 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4417 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4418 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4419
4420 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4421 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4422 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4423 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4424 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4425 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4426 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4427 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4428 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4429
4430 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4431 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4432 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4433
4434 @node Auto Display
4435 @section Automatic display
4436 @cindex automatic display
4437 @cindex display of expressions
4438
4439 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4440 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4441 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4442 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4443 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4444 The automatic display looks like this:
4445
4446 @example
4447 2: foo = 38
4448 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4449 @end example
4450
4451 @noindent
4452 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4453 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4454 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4455 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4456 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4457 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4458 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4459
4460 @table @code
4461 @kindex display
4462 @item display @var{exp}
4463 Add the expression @var{exp} to the list of expressions to display
4464 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4465
4466 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4467
4468 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{exp}
4469 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4470 count, add the expression @var{exp} to the auto-display list but
4471 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4472 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4473
4474 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4475 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4476 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4477 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4478 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4479 @end table
4480
4481 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4482 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4483 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers}).
4484
4485 @table @code
4486 @kindex delete display
4487 @kindex undisplay
4488 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4489 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4490 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4491
4492 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4493 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4494
4495 @kindex disable display
4496 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4497 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4498 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4499 enabled again later.
4500
4501 @kindex enable display
4502 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4503 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4504 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4505
4506 @item display
4507 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4508 done when your program stops.
4509
4510 @kindex info display
4511 @item info display
4512 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4513 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4514 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4515 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4516 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4517 @end table
4518
4519 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4520 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4521 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4522 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4523 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4524 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4525 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4526 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4527 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4528 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4529
4530 @node Print Settings
4531 @section Print settings
4532
4533 @cindex format options
4534 @cindex print settings
4535 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4536 and symbols are printed.
4537
4538 @noindent
4539 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4540
4541 @table @code
4542 @kindex set print address
4543 @item set print address
4544 @itemx set print address on
4545 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4546 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4547 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4548 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4549 @code{set print address on}:
4550
4551 @smallexample
4552 @group
4553 (@value{GDBP}) f
4554 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4555 at input.c:530
4556 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4557 @end group
4558 @end smallexample
4559
4560 @item set print address off
4561 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4562 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4563
4564 @smallexample
4565 @group
4566 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4567 (@value{GDBP}) f
4568 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4569 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4570 @end group
4571 @end smallexample
4572
4573 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4574 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4575 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4576 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4577
4578 @kindex show print address
4579 @item show print address
4580 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4581 @end table
4582
4583 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4584 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4585 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4586 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4587 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4588 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4589 it prints a symbolic address:
4590
4591 @table @code
4592 @kindex set print symbol-filename
4593 @item set print symbol-filename on
4594 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4595 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4596
4597 @item set print symbol-filename off
4598 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4599 default.
4600
4601 @kindex show print symbol-filename
4602 @item show print symbol-filename
4603 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4604 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4605 @end table
4606
4607 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4608 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4609 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4610
4611 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4612 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4613
4614 @table @code
4615 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4616 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4617 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4618 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4619 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4620 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4621
4622 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4623 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
4624 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4625 symbolic address.
4626 @end table
4627
4628 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4629 @cindex pointer, finding referent
4630 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4631 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4632 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4633 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4634 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4635 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4636
4637 @example
4638 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4639 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4640 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4641 @end example
4642
4643 @quotation
4644 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4645 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4646 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4647 @end quotation
4648
4649 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4650
4651 @table @code
4652 @kindex set print array
4653 @item set print array
4654 @itemx set print array on
4655 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4656 but uses more space. The default is off.
4657
4658 @item set print array off
4659 Return to compressed format for arrays.
4660
4661 @kindex show print array
4662 @item show print array
4663 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
4664 arrays.
4665
4666 @kindex set print elements
4667 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
4668 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
4669 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
4670 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
4671 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
4672 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
4673
4674 @kindex show print elements
4675 @item show print elements
4676 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
4677 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
4678
4679 @kindex set print null-stop
4680 @item set print null-stop
4681 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
4682 @sc{NULL} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
4683 contain only short strings.
4684
4685 @kindex set print pretty
4686 @item set print pretty on
4687 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
4688 per line, like this:
4689
4690 @smallexample
4691 @group
4692 $1 = @{
4693 next = 0x0,
4694 flags = @{
4695 sweet = 1,
4696 sour = 1
4697 @},
4698 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
4699 @}
4700 @end group
4701 @end smallexample
4702
4703 @item set print pretty off
4704 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
4705
4706 @smallexample
4707 @group
4708 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
4709 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
4710 @end group
4711 @end smallexample
4712
4713 @noindent
4714 This is the default format.
4715
4716 @kindex show print pretty
4717 @item show print pretty
4718 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
4719
4720 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
4721 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
4722 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
4723 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
4724 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
4725 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
4726 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
4727
4728 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
4729 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
4730 international character sets, and is the default.
4731
4732 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
4733 @item show print sevenbit-strings
4734 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
4735
4736 @kindex set print union
4737 @item set print union on
4738 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
4739 is the default setting.
4740
4741 @item set print union off
4742 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
4743
4744 @kindex show print union
4745 @item show print union
4746 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
4747 structures.
4748
4749 For example, given the declarations
4750
4751 @smallexample
4752 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
4753 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
4754 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
4755 Bug_forms;
4756
4757 struct thing @{
4758 Species it;
4759 union @{
4760 Tree_forms tree;
4761 Bug_forms bug;
4762 @} form;
4763 @};
4764
4765 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
4766 @end smallexample
4767
4768 @noindent
4769 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
4770
4771 @smallexample
4772 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
4773 @end smallexample
4774
4775 @noindent
4776 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
4777
4778 @smallexample
4779 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
4780 @end smallexample
4781 @end table
4782
4783 @need 1000
4784 @noindent
4785 These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
4786
4787 @table @code
4788 @cindex demangling
4789 @kindex set print demangle
4790 @item set print demangle
4791 @itemx set print demangle on
4792 Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
4793 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
4794 linkage. The default is @samp{on}.
4795
4796 @kindex show print demangle
4797 @item show print demangle
4798 Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
4799
4800 @kindex set print asm-demangle
4801 @item set print asm-demangle
4802 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
4803 Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
4804 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
4805 The default is off.
4806
4807 @kindex show print asm-demangle
4808 @item show print asm-demangle
4809 Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
4810 or demangled form.
4811
4812 @kindex set demangle-style
4813 @cindex C++ symbol decoding style
4814 @cindex symbol decoding style, C++
4815 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
4816 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
4817 represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
4818
4819 @table @code
4820 @item auto
4821 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
4822
4823 @item gnu
4824 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
4825 This is the default.
4826
4827 @item hp
4828 Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
4829
4830 @item lucid
4831 Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
4832
4833 @item arm
4834 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
4835 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
4836 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
4837 require further enhancement to permit that.
4838
4839 @end table
4840 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
4841
4842 @kindex show demangle-style
4843 @item show demangle-style
4844 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
4845
4846 @kindex set print object
4847 @item set print object
4848 @itemx set print object on
4849 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
4850 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
4851 the virtual function table.
4852
4853 @item set print object off
4854 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
4855 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
4856
4857 @kindex show print object
4858 @item show print object
4859 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
4860
4861 @kindex set print static-members
4862 @item set print static-members
4863 @itemx set print static-members on
4864 Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
4865
4866 @item set print static-members off
4867 Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
4868
4869 @kindex show print static-members
4870 @item show print static-members
4871 Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
4872
4873 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
4874 @kindex set print vtbl
4875 @item set print vtbl
4876 @itemx set print vtbl on
4877 Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
4878 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
4879 ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
4880
4881 @item set print vtbl off
4882 Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
4883
4884 @kindex show print vtbl
4885 @item show print vtbl
4886 Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
4887 @end table
4888
4889 @node Value History
4890 @section Value history
4891
4892 @cindex value history
4893 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
4894 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
4895 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
4896 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
4897 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
4898 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
4899 symbol table.
4900
4901 @cindex @code{$}
4902 @cindex @code{$$}
4903 @cindex history number
4904 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
4905 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
4906 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
4907 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
4908 history number.
4909
4910 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
4911 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
4912 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
4913 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
4914 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
4915 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
4916 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
4917
4918 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
4919 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
4920
4921 @example
4922 p *$
4923 @end example
4924
4925 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
4926 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
4927
4928 @example
4929 p *$.next
4930 @end example
4931
4932 @noindent
4933 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
4934 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
4935
4936 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
4937 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
4938
4939 @example
4940 print x
4941 set x=5
4942 @end example
4943
4944 @noindent
4945 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
4946 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
4947
4948 @table @code
4949 @kindex show values
4950 @item show values
4951 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
4952 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
4953 values} does not change the history.
4954
4955 @item show values @var{n}
4956 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
4957
4958 @item show values +
4959 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
4960 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
4961 @end table
4962
4963 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
4964 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
4965
4966 @node Convenience Vars
4967 @section Convenience variables
4968
4969 @cindex convenience variables
4970 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
4971 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
4972 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
4973 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
4974 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
4975
4976 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
4977 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
4978 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers}).
4979 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
4980 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
4981
4982 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
4983 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
4984 For example:
4985
4986 @example
4987 set $foo = *object_ptr
4988 @end example
4989
4990 @noindent
4991 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
4992 @code{object_ptr}.
4993
4994 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
4995 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
4996 value with another assignment at any time.
4997
4998 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
4999 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5000 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5001 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5002
5003 @table @code
5004 @kindex show convenience
5005 @item show convenience
5006 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5007 Abbreviated @code{show con}.
5008 @end table
5009
5010 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5011 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5012 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5013
5014 @example
5015 set $i = 0
5016 print bar[$i++]->contents
5017 @end example
5018
5019 @noindent Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5020
5021 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5022 values likely to be useful.
5023
5024 @table @code
5025 @kindex $_
5026 @item $_
5027 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5028 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5029 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5030 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5031 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5032 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5033 to the type of @code{$__}.
5034
5035 @kindex $__
5036 @item $__
5037 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5038 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5039 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5040
5041 @item $_exitcode
5042 @kindex $_exitcode
5043 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5044 the program being debugged terminates.
5045 @end table
5046
5047 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5048 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5049 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5050
5051 @node Registers
5052 @section Registers
5053
5054 @cindex registers
5055 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5056 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5057 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5058 your machine.
5059
5060 @table @code
5061 @kindex info registers
5062 @item info registers
5063 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5064 registers (in the selected stack frame).
5065
5066 @kindex info all-registers
5067 @cindex floating point registers
5068 @item info all-registers
5069 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5070 registers.
5071
5072 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5073 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5074 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5075 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5076 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5077 @end table
5078
5079 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5080 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5081 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5082 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5083 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5084 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5085 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5086 you could print the program counter in hex with
5087
5088 @example
5089 p/x $pc
5090 @end example
5091
5092 @noindent
5093 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5094
5095 @example
5096 x/i $pc
5097 @end example
5098
5099 @noindent
5100 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5101 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5102 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5103 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5104 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5105 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5106 @pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5107
5108 @example
5109 set $sp += 4
5110 @end example
5111
5112 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5113 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5114 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5115 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5116 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5117 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}.
5118
5119 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5120 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5121 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5122 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5123 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5124 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5125 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5126
5127 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5128 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5129 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5130 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5131 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5132 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5133 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5134 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5135 prints the data in both formats.
5136
5137 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5138 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5139 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5140 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5141 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5142 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5143
5144 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5145 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5146 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5147 frame makes no difference.
5148
5149 @node Floating Point Hardware
5150 @section Floating point hardware
5151 @cindex floating point
5152
5153 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5154 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5155
5156 @table @code
5157 @kindex info float
5158 @item info float
5159 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5160 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5161 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5162 the ARM and x86 machines.
5163 @end table
5164
5165 @node Languages
5166 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5167 @cindex languages
5168
5169 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5170 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5171 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5172 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5173 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
5174 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
5175
5176 @cindex working language
5177 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5178 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5179 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5180 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5181 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5182 language}.
5183
5184 @menu
5185 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
5186 * Show:: Displaying the language
5187 * Checks:: Type and range checks
5188 * Support:: Supported languages
5189 @end menu
5190
5191 @node Setting
5192 @section Switching between source languages
5193
5194 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5195 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5196 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5197 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5198 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5199 are printed, etc.
5200
5201 In addition to the working language, every source file that
5202 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5203 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5204 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5205 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5206 controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5207 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
5208 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}.
5209
5210 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5211 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
5212 another language. In that case, make the
5213 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5214 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5215 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5216
5217 @menu
5218 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5219 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5220 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5221 @end menu
5222
5223 @node Filenames
5224 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5225
5226 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5227 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5228
5229 @table @file
5230
5231 @item .c
5232 C source file
5233
5234 @item .C
5235 @itemx .cc
5236 @itemx .cp
5237 @itemx .cpp
5238 @itemx .cxx
5239 @itemx .c++
5240 C++ source file
5241
5242 @item .f
5243 @itemx .F
5244 Fortran source file
5245
5246 @item .ch
5247 @itemx .c186
5248 @itemx .c286
5249 CHILL source file.
5250
5251 @item .mod
5252 Modula-2 source file
5253
5254 @item .s
5255 @itemx .S
5256 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5257 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5258 @end table
5259
5260 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5261 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5262
5263 @node Manually
5264 @subsection Setting the working language
5265
5266 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5267 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5268 your program.
5269
5270 @kindex set language
5271 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5272 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5273 a language, such as
5274 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
5275 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5276
5277 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5278 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5279 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5280 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5281 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5282 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5283 command such as:
5284
5285 @example
5286 print a = b + c
5287 @end example
5288
5289 @noindent
5290 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5291 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5292 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5293 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
5294
5295 @node Automatically
5296 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5297
5298 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5299 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5300 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5301 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5302 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5303 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5304 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5305 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5306 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5307
5308 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5309 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5310 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5311 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5312 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5313
5314 @node Show
5315 @section Displaying the language
5316
5317 The following commands help you find out which language is the
5318 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5319
5320 @kindex show language
5321 @kindex info frame
5322 @kindex info source
5323 @table @code
5324 @item show language
5325 Display the current working language. This is the
5326 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5327 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5328
5329 @item info frame
5330 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
5331 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5332 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
5333 information listed here.
5334
5335 @item info source
5336 Display the source language of this source file.
5337 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
5338 information listed here.
5339 @end table
5340
5341 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5342 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5343 with a language explicitly:
5344
5345 @kindex set extension-language
5346 @kindex info extensions
5347 @table @code
5348 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5349 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5350 the source language @var{language}.
5351
5352 @item info extensions
5353 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5354 @end table
5355
5356 @node Checks
5357 @section Type and range checking
5358
5359 @quotation
5360 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5361 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5362 section documents the intended facilities.
5363 @end quotation
5364 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5365
5366 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5367 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5368 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5369 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5370 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5371 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5372 errors when your program is running.
5373
5374 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5375 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5376 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5377 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5378 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5379 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5380 for the default settings of supported languages.
5381
5382 @menu
5383 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5384 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5385 @end menu
5386
5387 @cindex type checking
5388 @cindex checks, type
5389 @node Type Checking
5390 @subsection An overview of type checking
5391
5392 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5393 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5394 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5395 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5396
5397 @smallexample
5398 1 + 2 @result{} 3
5399 @exdent but
5400 @error{} 1 + 2.3
5401 @end smallexample
5402
5403 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5404 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5405
5406 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5407 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5408 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5409 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
5410 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5411 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5412 also issues a warning.
5413
5414 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5415 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5416 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5417 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5418 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
5419 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5420
5421 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5422 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5423 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5424 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5425 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5426 details on specific languages.
5427
5428 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5429
5430 @kindex set check
5431 @kindex set check type
5432 @kindex show check type
5433 @table @code
5434 @item set check type auto
5435 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5436 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5437 each language.
5438
5439 @item set check type on
5440 @itemx set check type off
5441 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5442 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5443 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
5444 evaluating an expression while typechecking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
5445 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5446
5447 @item set check type warn
5448 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5449 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5450 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5451 numbers and structures.
5452
5453 @item show type
5454 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
5455 is setting it automatically.
5456 @end table
5457
5458 @cindex range checking
5459 @cindex checks, range
5460 @node Range Checking
5461 @subsection An overview of range checking
5462
5463 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5464 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5465 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5466 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5467 not exceed the bounds of the array.
5468
5469 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5470 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5471 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5472 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5473
5474 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5475 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5476 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5477 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5478 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5479 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5480
5481 @example
5482 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5483 @end example
5484
5485 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5486 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5487 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5488
5489 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5490
5491 @kindex set check
5492 @kindex set check range
5493 @kindex show check range
5494 @table @code
5495 @item set check range auto
5496 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5497 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5498 each language.
5499
5500 @item set check range on
5501 @itemx set check range off
5502 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5503 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
5504 match the language default. If a range error occurs, then a message
5505 is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
5506
5507 @item set check range warn
5508 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5509 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5510 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5511 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5512 systems).
5513
5514 @item show range
5515 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5516 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5517 @end table
5518
5519 @node Support
5520 @section Supported languages
5521
5522 @value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5523 @c This is false ...
5524 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5525 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5526 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5527 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5528 language.
5529
5530 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5531 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
5532 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5533 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5534 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
5535 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5536 language reference or tutorial.
5537
5538 @menu
5539 * C:: C and C++
5540 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
5541 * Chill:: Chill
5542 @end menu
5543
5544 @node C
5545 @subsection C and C++
5546
5547 @cindex C and C++
5548 @cindex expressions in C or C++
5549
5550 Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5551 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5552 together.
5553
5554 @cindex C++
5555 @kindex g++
5556 @cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5557 The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5558 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5559 effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5560 C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5561 compiler (@code{aCC}).
5562
5563 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5564 format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5565 command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
5566 @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5567 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
5568
5569 @menu
5570 * C Operators:: C and C++ operators
5571 * C Constants:: C and C++ constants
5572 * C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
5573 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
5574 * C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
5575 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
5576 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
5577 @end menu
5578
5579 @node C Operators
5580 @subsubsection C and C++ operators
5581
5582 @cindex C and C++ operators
5583
5584 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
5585 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5586 often defined on groups of types.
5587
5588 For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
5589
5590 @itemize @bullet
5591
5592 @item
5593 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5594 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
5595
5596 @item
5597 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float} and @code{double}.
5598
5599 @item
5600 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
5601
5602 @item
5603 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
5604
5605 @end itemize
5606
5607 @noindent
5608 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
5609 in order of increasing precedence:
5610
5611 @table @code
5612 @item ,
5613 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
5614 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5615 expression being the last expression evaluated.
5616
5617 @item =
5618 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
5619 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
5620
5621 @item @var{op}=
5622 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5623 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
5624 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precendence.
5625 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5626 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5627
5628 @item ?:
5629 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5630 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
5631 integral type.
5632
5633 @item ||
5634 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5635
5636 @item &&
5637 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5638
5639 @item |
5640 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5641
5642 @item ^
5643 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5644
5645 @item &
5646 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5647
5648 @item ==@r{, }!=
5649 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
5650 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5651
5652 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5653 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5654 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
5655 and non-zero for true.
5656
5657 @item <<@r{, }>>
5658 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
5659
5660 @item @@
5661 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
5662
5663 @item +@r{, }-
5664 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
5665 pointer types.
5666
5667 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
5668 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
5669 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
5670 integral types.
5671
5672 @item ++@r{, }--
5673 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
5674 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
5675 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
5676 operation takes place.
5677
5678 @item *
5679 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
5680 @code{++}.
5681
5682 @item &
5683 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
5684
5685 For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
5686 allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
5687 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
5688 where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
5689 stored.
5690
5691 @item -
5692 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
5693 precedence as @code{++}.
5694
5695 @item !
5696 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5697 @code{++}.
5698
5699 @item ~
5700 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5701 @code{++}.
5702
5703
5704 @item .@r{, }->
5705 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
5706 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
5707 pointer based on the stored type information.
5708 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
5709
5710 @item .*@r{, }->*
5711 Dereferences of pointers to members.
5712
5713 @item []
5714 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
5715 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5716
5717 @item ()
5718 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5719
5720 @item ::
5721 C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
5722 and @code{class} types.
5723
5724 @item ::
5725 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
5726 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
5727 above.
5728 @end table
5729
5730 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
5731 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
5732 predefined meaning.
5733
5734 @menu
5735 * C Constants::
5736 @end menu
5737
5738 @node C Constants
5739 @subsubsection C and C++ constants
5740
5741 @cindex C and C++ constants
5742
5743 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
5744 following ways:
5745
5746 @itemize @bullet
5747 @item
5748 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
5749 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
5750 a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
5751 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
5752 @code{long} value.
5753
5754 @item
5755 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
5756 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
5757 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
5758 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
5759 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
5760
5761 @item
5762 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
5763 integral equivalents.
5764
5765 @item
5766 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
5767 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
5768 (usually its @sc{ASCII} value). Within quotes, the single character may
5769 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
5770 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
5771 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
5772 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
5773 @samp{\n} for newline.
5774
5775 @item
5776 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded
5777 by double quotes (@code{"}).
5778
5779 @item
5780 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
5781 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
5782
5783 @item
5784 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
5785 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
5786 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
5787 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
5788 @end itemize
5789
5790 @menu
5791 * C plus plus expressions::
5792 * C Defaults::
5793 * C Checks::
5794
5795 * Debugging C::
5796 @end menu
5797
5798 @node C plus plus expressions
5799 @subsubsection C++ expressions
5800
5801 @cindex expressions in C++
5802 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
5803
5804 @cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
5805 @cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
5806 @cindex C++ and object formats
5807 @cindex object formats and C++
5808 @cindex a.out and C++
5809 @cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
5810 @cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
5811 @cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
5812 @cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
5813 @c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
5814 @c periodically whether this has happened...
5815 @quotation
5816 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
5817 proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
5818 additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
5819 special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
5820 @sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
5821 symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
5822 you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
5823 extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
5824 @sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
5825 support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
5826 @end quotation
5827
5828 @enumerate
5829
5830 @cindex member functions
5831 @item
5832 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
5833
5834 @example
5835 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
5836 @end example
5837
5838 @kindex this
5839 @cindex namespace in C++
5840 @item
5841 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
5842 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
5843 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
5844 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
5845
5846 @cindex call overloaded functions
5847 @cindex overloaded functions
5848 @cindex type conversions in C++
5849 @item
5850 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
5851 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. GDB does not
5852 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
5853 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
5854 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
5855 default arguments.
5856
5857 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
5858 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
5859 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
5860 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
5861 number of function arguments.
5862
5863 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
5864 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
5865 ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
5866
5867 You must specify@code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
5868 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
5869 @smallexample
5870 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
5871 @end smallexample
5872 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
5873 @pxref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
5874
5875 @cindex reference declarations
5876 @item
5877 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
5878 them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
5879 dereferenced.
5880
5881 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
5882 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
5883 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
5884 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
5885 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
5886
5887 @item
5888 @value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
5889 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
5890 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
5891 necessary, for example in an expression like
5892 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
5893 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
5894 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
5895 @end enumerate
5896
5897 In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
5898 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
5899 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
5900 invoking user-defined operators.
5901
5902 @node C Defaults
5903 @subsubsection C and C++ defaults
5904
5905 @cindex C and C++ defaults
5906
5907 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
5908 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
5909 C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
5910 selects the working language.
5911
5912 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
5913 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
5914 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
5915 these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
5916 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
5917 for further details.
5918
5919 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
5920 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
5921 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
5922
5923 @node C Checks
5924 @subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
5925
5926 @cindex C and C++ checks
5927
5928 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
5929 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
5930 considers two variables type equivalent if:
5931
5932 @itemize @bullet
5933 @item
5934 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
5935 enumerated tag.
5936
5937 @item
5938 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
5939 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
5940
5941 @ignore
5942 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
5943 @c FIXME--beers?
5944 @item
5945 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
5946 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
5947 compilers.)
5948 @end ignore
5949 @end itemize
5950
5951 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
5952 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
5953 that is not itself an array.
5954
5955 @node Debugging C
5956 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
5957
5958 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
5959 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
5960 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
5961 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
5962
5963 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
5964 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
5965 ,Expressions}.
5966
5967 @menu
5968 * Debugging C plus plus::
5969 @end menu
5970
5971 @node Debugging C plus plus
5972 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
5973
5974 @cindex commands for C++
5975
5976 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
5977 designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
5978
5979 @table @code
5980 @cindex break in overloaded functions
5981 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
5982 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
5983 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
5984 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
5985
5986 @cindex overloading in C++
5987 @item rbreak @var{regex}
5988 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
5989 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
5990 classes.
5991 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
5992
5993 @cindex C++ exception handling
5994 @item catch throw
5995 @itemx catch catch
5996 Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
5997 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
5998
5999 @cindex inheritance
6000 @item ptype @var{typename}
6001 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6002 @var{typename}.
6003 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6004
6005 @cindex C++ symbol display
6006 @item set print demangle
6007 @itemx show print demangle
6008 @itemx set print asm-demangle
6009 @itemx show print asm-demangle
6010 Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6011 displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6012 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6013
6014 @item set print object
6015 @itemx show print object
6016 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6017 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6018
6019 @item set print vtbl
6020 @itemx show print vtbl
6021 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6022 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6023 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6024 ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6025
6026 @kindex set overload-resolution
6027 @cindex overloaded functions
6028 @item set overload-resolution on
6029 Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6030 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6031 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
6032 using the standard C++ conversion rules (@pxref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6033 expressions} for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
6034 message.
6035
6036 @item set overload-resolution off
6037 Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6038 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6039 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6040 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6041 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6042 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6043 argument types.
6044
6045 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6046 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6047 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6048 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6049 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6050 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6051 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6052 @end table
6053
6054 @node Modula-2
6055 @subsection Modula-2
6056
6057 @cindex Modula-2
6058
6059 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6060 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6061 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6062 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6063 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6064 table.
6065
6066 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
6067 @menu
6068 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6069 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6070 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6071 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6072 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6073 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6074 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6075 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6076 @end menu
6077
6078 @node M2 Operators
6079 @subsubsection Operators
6080 @cindex Modula-2 operators
6081
6082 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6083 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6084 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6085 following definitions hold:
6086
6087 @itemize @bullet
6088
6089 @item
6090 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6091 their subranges.
6092
6093 @item
6094 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6095
6096 @item
6097 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6098
6099 @item
6100 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6101 @var{type}}.
6102
6103 @item
6104 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6105
6106 @item
6107 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6108
6109 @item
6110 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6111 @end itemize
6112
6113 @noindent
6114 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6115 increasing precedence:
6116
6117 @table @code
6118 @item ,
6119 Function argument or array index separator.
6120
6121 @item :=
6122 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6123 @var{value}.
6124
6125 @item <@r{, }>
6126 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6127 types.
6128
6129 @item <=@r{, }>=
6130 Less than, greater than, less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
6131 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6132 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6133
6134 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6135 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6136 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6137 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6138 comment character.
6139
6140 @item IN
6141 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6142 Same precedence as @code{<}.
6143
6144 @item OR
6145 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6146
6147 @item AND@r{, }&
6148 Boolean conjuction. Defined on boolean types.
6149
6150 @item @@
6151 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6152
6153 @item +@r{, }-
6154 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6155 and difference on set types.
6156
6157 @item *
6158 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6159 on set types.
6160
6161 @item /
6162 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6163 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6164
6165 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
6166 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6167 precedence as @code{*}.
6168
6169 @item -
6170 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6171
6172 @item ^
6173 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6174
6175 @item NOT
6176 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6177 @code{^}.
6178
6179 @item .
6180 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6181 precedence as @code{^}.
6182
6183 @item []
6184 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6185
6186 @item ()
6187 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6188 as @code{^}.
6189
6190 @item ::@r{, }.
6191 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6192 @end table
6193
6194 @quotation
6195 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6196 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6197 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6198 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6199 @end quotation
6200
6201 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6202 @node Built-In Func/Proc
6203 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6204
6205 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6206 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6207
6208 @table @var
6209
6210 @item a
6211 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6212
6213 @item c
6214 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6215
6216 @item i
6217 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6218
6219 @item m
6220 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6221 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6222 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6223
6224 @item n
6225 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6226
6227 @item r
6228 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6229
6230 @item t
6231 represents a type.
6232
6233 @item v
6234 represents a variable.
6235
6236 @item x
6237 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6238 explanation of the function for details.
6239 @end table
6240
6241 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6242
6243 @table @code
6244 @item ABS(@var{n})
6245 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6246
6247 @item CAP(@var{c})
6248 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
6249 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument
6250
6251 @item CHR(@var{i})
6252 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6253
6254 @item DEC(@var{v})
6255 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v}. Returns the new value.
6256
6257 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6258 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6259 new value.
6260
6261 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6262 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6263 set.
6264
6265 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
6266 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6267
6268 @item HIGH(@var{a})
6269 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6270
6271 @item INC(@var{v})
6272 Increments the value in the variable @var{v}. Returns the new value.
6273
6274 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6275 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6276 new value.
6277
6278 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6279 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6280 there. Returns the new set.
6281
6282 @item MAX(@var{t})
6283 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6284
6285 @item MIN(@var{t})
6286 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6287
6288 @item ODD(@var{i})
6289 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6290
6291 @item ORD(@var{x})
6292 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
6293 value of a character is its ASCII value (on machines supporting the
6294 ASCII character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
6295 integral, character and enumerated types.
6296
6297 @item SIZE(@var{x})
6298 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6299
6300 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
6301 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6302
6303 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6304 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6305 @end table
6306
6307 @quotation
6308 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6309 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6310 an error.
6311 @end quotation
6312
6313 @cindex Modula-2 constants
6314 @node M2 Constants
6315 @subsubsection Constants
6316
6317 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6318 ways:
6319
6320 @itemize @bullet
6321
6322 @item
6323 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6324 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6325 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6326 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6327
6328 @item
6329 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6330 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6331 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6332 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6333 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6334 digits.
6335
6336 @item
6337 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6338 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
6339 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their ASCII value, usually)
6340 followed by a @samp{C}.
6341
6342 @item
6343 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6344 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6345 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6346 Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6347 sequences.
6348
6349 @item
6350 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6351
6352 @item
6353 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6354 @code{FALSE}.
6355
6356 @item
6357 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6358
6359 @item
6360 Set constants are not yet supported.
6361 @end itemize
6362
6363 @node M2 Defaults
6364 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6365 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
6366
6367 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6368 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
6369 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you, or @value{GDBN},
6370 selected the working language.
6371
6372 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6373 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
6374 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
6375 the language automatically}, for further details.
6376
6377 @node Deviations
6378 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6379 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6380
6381 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6382 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6383
6384 @itemize @bullet
6385 @item
6386 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6387 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6388 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6389 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6390 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6391 returned a pointer.)
6392
6393 @item
6394 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6395 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6396 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6397 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6398
6399 @item
6400 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6401 argument.
6402
6403 @item
6404 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6405 @end itemize
6406
6407 @node M2 Checks
6408 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6409 @cindex Modula-2 checks
6410
6411 @quotation
6412 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6413 range checking.
6414 @end quotation
6415 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6416
6417 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6418
6419 @itemize @bullet
6420 @item
6421 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6422 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6423
6424 @item
6425 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6426 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6427 @end itemize
6428
6429 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6430 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6431
6432 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6433 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6434
6435 @node M2 Scope
6436 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6437 @cindex scope
6438 @kindex .
6439 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6440 @ifinfo
6441 @kindex colon-colon
6442 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6443 @end ifinfo
6444 @iftex
6445 @kindex ::
6446 @end iftex
6447
6448 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6449 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6450 similar syntax:
6451
6452 @example
6453
6454 @var{module} . @var{id}
6455 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
6456 @end example
6457
6458 @noindent
6459 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6460 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6461 identifier within your program, except another module.
6462
6463 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6464 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6465 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6466 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6467
6468 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6469 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6470 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6471 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6472 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6473 @var{module}.
6474
6475 @node GDB/M2
6476 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6477
6478 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6479 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6480 specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6481 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6482 apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6483 analogue in Modula-2.
6484
6485 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
6486 while using any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
6487 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6488 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6489 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
6490 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful. (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions})
6491
6492 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6493 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6494 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
6495
6496 @node Chill
6497 @subsection Chill
6498
6499 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
6500 from the GNU Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
6501 supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6502 likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6503 table.
6504
6505 This section covers the following Chill related topics and the features
6506 of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6507
6508 @menu
6509 * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6510 * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
6511 * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
6512 * Chill type and range checks::
6513 * Chill defaults::
6514 @end menu
6515
6516 @node How modes are displayed
6517 @subsubsection How modes are displayed
6518
6519 The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
6520 with the functionality of the GNU Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
6521 slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6522 provided modes are:
6523 @table @code
6524 @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6525 @itemize @bullet
6526 @item
6527 @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6528 UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6529 @item
6530 @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
6531 @item
6532 @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
6533 @item
6534 @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6535 @smallexample
6536 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6537 type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6538 @end smallexample
6539 If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6540 @item
6541 @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by @code{type = <basemode>
6542 (<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}, where @code{<lower bound>, <upper
6543 bound>} can be of any discrete literal expression (e.g. set element
6544 names).
6545 @end itemize
6546
6547 @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6548 A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
6549 the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
6550 @smallexample
6551 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6552 type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6553 @end smallexample
6554
6555 @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6556 @itemize @bullet
6557 @item
6558 @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is diplayed by the keyword @code{REF}
6559 followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6560 @item
6561 @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6562 @end itemize
6563
6564 @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6565 The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6566 <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
6567 list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
6568 the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
6569 all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6570
6571 @ignore
6572 @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6573 The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
6574 type, and is therefore not really of interest.
6575 @end ignore
6576
6577 @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
6578 @itemize @bullet
6579 @item
6580 @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by @code{EVENT (<event length>)},
6581 where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6582 @item
6583 @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)
6584 <buffer element mode>}, where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
6585 @end itemize
6586
6587 @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
6588 @itemize @bullet
6589 @item
6590 @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6591 @item
6592 @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6593 @end itemize
6594
6595 @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6596 Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6597
6598 @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6599 @itemize @bullet
6600 @item
6601 @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by @code{CHARS(<string
6602 length>)}, followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is
6603 a varying mode
6604 @item
6605 @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by @code{BOOLS(<string
6606 length>)}.
6607 @end itemize
6608
6609 @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6610 The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6611 followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6612 @smallexample
6613 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6614 type = ARRAY (1:42)
6615 ARRAY (1:20)
6616 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6617 @end smallexample
6618
6619 @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
6620 The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
6621 list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6622 of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6623 OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
6624 of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6625 checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6626 always displays all variant fields.
6627 @smallexample
6628 (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
6629 type = STRUCT (
6630 as x,
6631 bs x,
6632 CASE bs OF
6633 (karli):
6634 cs a
6635 (ott):
6636 ds x
6637 ESAC
6638 )
6639 @end smallexample
6640 @end table
6641
6642 @node Locations
6643 @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
6644
6645 A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
6646
6647 A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
6648 the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
6649 Chill programs. How values are specified
6650 is the topic of the next section.
6651
6652 The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
6653 display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
6654 @smallexample
6655 set result := EXPR
6656 @end smallexample
6657 - does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
6658 is not available in gdb).
6659
6660 Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
6661 value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
6662 mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
6663 represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
6664 value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
6665 operator `@code{->}'.
6666
6667 Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by @code{@{ PROC
6668 (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6669 location>}. @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the
6670 parameter specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the
6671 address of the entry point.
6672
6673 @ignore
6674 Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
6675 fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
6676 the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
6677 implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
6678 na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
6679 <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
6680 @code{__proc_copy}.
6681
6682 Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
6683 the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
6684 like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
6685 mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
6686
6687 Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
6688 ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
6689 definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
6690 of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
6691 structure mode the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
6692 braces (`@code{@{@}}'). Fields enclosed by `@code{@{,@}}' are residing
6693 on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
6694 memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
6695 all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
6696 @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
6697 stuff ???)
6698 @smallexample
6699 (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
6700 [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
6701 @end smallexample
6702 @end ignore
6703
6704 Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
6705 (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
6706 certain operations which are descibed in the next chapter.
6707
6708 A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
6709 location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
6710 name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
6711 have to be equal otherwise an error message occurs. Further no range
6712 checking of the location against the destination mode is performed and
6713 therefore the result can be quite confusing.
6714 @smallexample
6715 (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
6716 @end smallexample
6717
6718 @node Values and their Operations
6719 @subsubsection Values and their Operations
6720
6721 Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
6722 more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
6723 data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
6724 such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
6725 constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
6726 when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
6727 (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
6728 the values behind these locations.
6729
6730 This subchapters describes how values have to be specified and which
6731 operations are legal to be used with such values.
6732
6733 @table @code
6734 @item Literal Values
6735 Literal values are specified in the same manner as in GNU Chill programs.
6736 For detailed specification refer to the GNU Chill implementation Manual
6737 chapter 1.5.
6738
6739 @ignore
6740 @itemize @bullet
6741 @item
6742 @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
6743 programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
6744 @item
6745 @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
6746 @item
6747 @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
6748 @code{'M'})
6749 @item
6750 @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
6751 mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
6752 comparable to an enumaration in C/C++ language.
6753 @item
6754 @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
6755 emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
6756 procedure value or the empty instance value.
6757
6758 @item
6759 @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
6760 enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
6761 to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
6762 @item
6763 @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
6764 programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
6765 @item
6766 @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
6767 (gnu-)Chill programs (refer GNU Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
6768 @end itemize
6769 @end ignore
6770
6771 @item Tuple Values
6772 A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
6773 name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambigous. This
6774 unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
6775 @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
6776 @itemize @bullet
6777 @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
6778 @item @emph{Array Tuple}
6779 @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
6780 Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
6781 same manner as in Chill programs refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
6782 @end itemize
6783
6784 @item String Element Value
6785 A string element value is specified by @code{<string value>(<index>)},
6786 where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
6787 value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
6788 the string.
6789
6790 @item String Slice Value
6791 A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
6792 spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
6793 expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
6794 @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
6795 The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
6796 string.
6797
6798 @item Array Element Values
6799 An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
6800 delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
6801
6802 @item Array Slice Values
6803 An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
6804 @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
6805 @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
6806 arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
6807 which is part of the specified array.
6808
6809 @item Structure Field Values
6810 A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
6811 name>}, where @code{<field name>} indcates the name of a field specified
6812 in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
6813 corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
6814
6815 @item Procedure Call Value
6816 The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
6817 procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
6818 expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
6819 effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
6820
6821 Values of duration mode locations are represented by ULONG literals.
6822
6823 Values of time mode locations are represented by TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>).
6824
6825 @ignore
6826 This is not implemented yet:
6827 @item Built-in Value
6828 @noindent
6829 The following built in functions are provided:
6830 @table @code
6831 @item @code{ADDR()}
6832 @item @code{NUM()}
6833 @item @code{PRED()}
6834 @item @code{SUCC()}
6835 @item @code{ABS()}
6836 @item @code{CARD()}
6837 @item @code{MAX()}
6838 @item @code{MIN()}
6839 @item @code{SIZE()}
6840 @item @code{UPPER()}
6841 @item @code{LOWER()}
6842 @item @code{LENGTH()}
6843 @item @code{SIN()}
6844 @item @code{COS()}
6845 @item @code{TAN()}
6846 @item @code{ARCSIN()}
6847 @item @code{ARCCOS()}
6848 @item @code{ARCTAN()}
6849 @item @code{EXP()}
6850 @item @code{LN()}
6851 @item @code{LOG()}
6852 @item @code{SQRT()}
6853 @end table
6854
6855 For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
6856 chapter 1.6.
6857 @end ignore
6858
6859 @item Zero-adic Operator Value
6860 The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
6861 current active process.
6862
6863 @item Expression Values
6864 The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
6865 the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
6866 incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
6867 corresponding error message. Expressions may be paranthesised which
6868 causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
6869 which uses the result of the paranthesised expression. The following
6870 operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
6871 @table @code
6872 @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
6873 @item @code{AND, ANDIF}
6874 @item @code{NOT}
6875 Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
6876 @item @code{=, /=}
6877 Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
6878 @item @code{>, >=}
6879 @item @code{<, <=}
6880 Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
6881 @item @code{+, -}
6882 @item @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
6883 Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
6884 @item @code{-}
6885 Change sign operator.
6886 @item @code{//}
6887 String concatenation operator.
6888 @item @code{()}
6889 String repetition operator.
6890 @item @code{->}
6891 Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
6892 address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
6893 location (@code{loc->}).
6894 @item @code{OR, XOR}
6895 @item @code{AND}
6896 @item @code{NOT}
6897 Powerset and bitstring operators.
6898 @item @code{>, >=}
6899 @item @code{<, <=}
6900 Powerset inclusion operators.
6901 @item @code{IN}
6902 Membership operator.
6903 @end table
6904 @end table
6905
6906 @node Chill type and range checks
6907 @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
6908
6909 @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
6910 of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
6911 complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
6912 eqivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
6913 structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
6914
6915 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6916 index bounds and all built in procedures.
6917
6918 Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
6919 check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
6920 operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
6921 functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
6922 language specification.
6923
6924 @noindent
6925 All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
6926 off}.
6927
6928 @ignore
6929 @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
6930 see last paragraph ?
6931 @end ignore
6932
6933 @node Chill defaults
6934 @subsubsection Chill defaults
6935
6936 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6937 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
6938 Chill. This happens regardless of whether you, or @value{GDBN},
6939 selected the working language.
6940
6941 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6942 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
6943 working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
6944 the language automatically}, for further details.
6945
6946 @node Symbols
6947 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
6948
6949 The commands described in this section allow you to inquire about the
6950 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
6951 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
6952 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
6953 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
6954 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
6955 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
6956
6957 @cindex symbol names
6958 @cindex names of symbols
6959 @cindex quoting names
6960 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
6961 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
6962 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
6963 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
6964 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
6965 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
6966 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
6967 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
6968
6969 @example
6970 p 'foo.c'::x
6971 @end example
6972
6973 @noindent
6974 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
6975
6976 @table @code
6977 @kindex info address
6978 @item info address @var{symbol}
6979 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
6980 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
6981 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
6982 is always stored.
6983
6984 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
6985 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
6986 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
6987
6988 @kindex whatis
6989 @item whatis @var{exp}
6990 Print the data type of expression @var{exp}. @var{exp} is not
6991 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
6992 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
6993 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6994
6995 @item whatis
6996 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
6997
6998 @kindex ptype
6999 @item ptype @var{typename}
7000 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7001 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7002 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7003 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
7004
7005 @item ptype @var{exp}
7006 @itemx ptype
7007 Print a description of the type of expression @var{exp}. @code{ptype}
7008 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7009 of just the name of the type.
7010
7011 For example, for this variable declaration:
7012
7013 @example
7014 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7015 @end example
7016
7017 @noindent
7018 the two commands give this output:
7019
7020 @example
7021 @group
7022 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7023 type = struct complex
7024 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7025 type = struct complex @{
7026 double real;
7027 double imag;
7028 @}
7029 @end group
7030 @end example
7031
7032 @noindent
7033 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7034 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7035
7036 @kindex info types
7037 @item info types @var{regexp}
7038 @itemx info types
7039 Print a brief description of all types whose name matches @var{regexp}
7040 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7041 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7042 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
7043 name includes the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
7044 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7045
7046 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7047 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7048 lists all source files where a type is defined.
7049
7050 @kindex info source
7051 @item info source
7052 Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7053 the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7054 it was written in.
7055
7056 @kindex info sources
7057 @item info sources
7058 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7059 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7060 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7061
7062 @kindex info functions
7063 @item info functions
7064 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7065
7066 @item info functions @var{regexp}
7067 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7068 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7069 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7070 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7071 start with @code{step}.
7072
7073 @kindex info variables
7074 @item info variables
7075 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7076 outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7077
7078 @item info variables @var{regexp}
7079 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7080 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7081 @var{regexp}.
7082
7083 @ignore
7084 This was never implemented.
7085 @kindex info methods
7086 @item info methods
7087 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7088 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7089 methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7090 specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7091 C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7092 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7093 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7094 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7095 @end ignore
7096
7097 @cindex reloading symbols
7098 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7099 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7100 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7101 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7102 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
7103
7104 @table @code
7105 @kindex set symbol-reloading
7106 @item set symbol-reloading on
7107 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7108 object file with a particular name is seen again.
7109
7110 @item set symbol-reloading off
7111 Do not replace symbol definitions when re-encountering object files of
7112 the same name. This is the default state; if you are not running on a
7113 system that permits automatically relinking modules, you should leave
7114 @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN} may discard symbols
7115 when linking large programs, that may contain several modules (from
7116 different directories or libraries) with the same name.
7117
7118 @kindex show symbol-reloading
7119 @item show symbol-reloading
7120 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7121 @end table
7122
7123 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7124 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
7125 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7126 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7127 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7128 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7129 another source file. The default is on.
7130
7131 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7132 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7133
7134 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
7135 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7136 is printed as follows:
7137 @smallexample
7138 @{<no data fields>@}
7139 @end smallexample
7140
7141 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7142 @item show opaque-type-resolution
7143 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
7144
7145 @kindex maint print symbols
7146 @cindex symbol dump
7147 @kindex maint print psymbols
7148 @cindex partial symbol dump
7149 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7150 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7151 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7152 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7153 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7154 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7155 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7156 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7157 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7158 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7159 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7160 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7161 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7162 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7163 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7164 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7165 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7166 @end table
7167
7168 @node Altering
7169 @chapter Altering Execution
7170
7171 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7172 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7173 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7174 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7175 program.
7176
7177 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7178 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7179 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
7180
7181 @menu
7182 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7183 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
7184 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
7185 * Returning:: Returning from a function
7186 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7187 * Patching:: Patching your program
7188 @end menu
7189
7190 @node Assignment
7191 @section Assignment to variables
7192
7193 @cindex assignment
7194 @cindex setting variables
7195 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7196 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7197
7198 @example
7199 print x=4
7200 @end example
7201
7202 @noindent
7203 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
7204 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
7205 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7206 information on operators in supported languages.
7207
7208 @kindex set variable
7209 @cindex variables, setting
7210 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7211 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7212 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7213 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7214 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7215
7216 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7217 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7218 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7219 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7220 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7221 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7222 command @code{set width}:
7223
7224 @example
7225 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7226 type = double
7227 (@value{GDBP}) p width
7228 $4 = 13
7229 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7230 Invalid syntax in expression.
7231 @end example
7232
7233 @noindent
7234 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7235 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7236
7237 @example
7238 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7239 @end example
7240
7241 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7242 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7243 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7244 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7245 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7246 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7247
7248 @example
7249 @group
7250 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7251 type = double
7252 (@value{GDBP}) p g
7253 $1 = 1
7254 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
7255 (gdb) p g
7256 $2 = 1
7257 (@value{GDBP}) r
7258 The program being debugged has been started already.
7259 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7260 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
7261 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols: Invalid bfd target.
7262 (@value{GDBP}) show g
7263 The current BFD target is "=4".
7264 @end group
7265 @end example
7266
7267 @noindent
7268 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7269 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7270 @code{g}, use
7271
7272 @example
7273 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7274 @end example
7275
7276 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7277 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7278 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7279 same length or shorter.
7280 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7281 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7282
7283 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7284 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7285 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7286 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7287 and representation in memory), and
7288
7289 @example
7290 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7291 @end example
7292
7293 @noindent
7294 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7295
7296 @node Jumping
7297 @section Continuing at a different address
7298
7299 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7300 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7301 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7302
7303 @table @code
7304 @kindex jump
7305 @item jump @var{linespec}
7306 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7307 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7308 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7309 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7310 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7311 breakpoints}.
7312
7313 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7314 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7315 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7316 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7317 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7318 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7319 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7320 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7321 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7322
7323 @item jump *@var{address}
7324 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7325 @end table
7326
7327 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
7328 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7329 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7330 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7331 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7332 example,
7333
7334 @example
7335 set $pc = 0x485
7336 @end example
7337
7338 @noindent
7339 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7340 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7341 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
7342
7343 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7344 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7345 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7346 detail.
7347
7348 @c @group
7349 @node Signaling
7350 @section Giving your program a signal
7351
7352 @table @code
7353 @kindex signal
7354 @item signal @var{signal}
7355 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7356 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7357 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7358 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7359
7360 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7361 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7362 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7363 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7364 signal.
7365
7366 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7367 after executing the command.
7368 @end table
7369 @c @end group
7370
7371 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7372 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7373 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7374 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7375 passes the signal directly to your program.
7376
7377
7378 @node Returning
7379 @section Returning from a function
7380
7381 @table @code
7382 @cindex returning from a function
7383 @kindex return
7384 @item return
7385 @itemx return @var{expression}
7386 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7387 command. If you give an
7388 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7389 value.
7390 @end table
7391
7392 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7393 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7394 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7395 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7396
7397 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7398 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7399 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7400 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7401 of functions.
7402
7403 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7404 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7405 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7406 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7407 selected stack frame returns naturally.
7408
7409 @node Calling
7410 @section Calling program functions
7411
7412 @cindex calling functions
7413 @kindex call
7414 @table @code
7415 @item call @var{expr}
7416 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7417 returned values.
7418 @end table
7419
7420 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7421 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
7422 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7423 is printed and saved in the value history.
7424
7425 For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7426 specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7427 calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7428 method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7429 that have separate instruction and data spaces.
7430
7431 @node Patching
7432 @section Patching programs
7433
7434 @cindex patching binaries
7435 @cindex writing into executables
7436 @cindex writing into corefiles
7437
7438 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7439 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7440 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7441 patching your program's binary.
7442
7443 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7444 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7445 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7446 repairs.
7447
7448 @table @code
7449 @kindex set write
7450 @item set write on
7451 @itemx set write off
7452 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7453 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
7454 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7455
7456 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7457 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7458 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
7459
7460 @item show write
7461 @kindex show write
7462 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7463 as well as reading.
7464 @end table
7465
7466 @node GDB Files
7467 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7468
7469 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7470 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7471 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7472 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
7473
7474 @menu
7475 * Files:: Commands to specify files
7476 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
7477 @end menu
7478
7479 @node Files
7480 @section Commands to specify files
7481
7482 @cindex symbol table
7483 @cindex core dump file
7484
7485 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
7486 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7487 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7488 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
7489
7490 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7491 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7492 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7493 to specify new files are useful.
7494
7495 @table @code
7496 @cindex executable file
7497 @kindex file
7498 @item file @var{filename}
7499 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
7500 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
7501 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
7502 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7503 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7504 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7505 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
7506 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7507
7508 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file
7509 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7510 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7511 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
7512 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7513 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
7514 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
7515 for more information.
7516
7517 @item file
7518 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7519 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7520
7521 @kindex exec-file
7522 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7523 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7524 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7525 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
7526 discard information on the executable file.
7527
7528 @kindex symbol-file
7529 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7530 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
7531 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7532 table and program to run from the same file.
7533
7534 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7535 program's symbol table.
7536
7537 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
7538 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7539 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
7540 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7541 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7542
7543 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7544 executing it once.
7545
7546 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7547 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7548 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7549 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
7550 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7551 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7552 optimized code.
7553
7554 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7555 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7556 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
7557 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
7558 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7559
7560 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7561 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
7562 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7563 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7564 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7565 warnings and messages}.)
7566
7567 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
7568 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7569 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7570 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7571 in stabs format.
7572
7573 @kindex readnow
7574 @cindex reading symbols immediately
7575 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
7576 @kindex mapped
7577 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7578 @cindex saving symbol table
7579 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7580 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7581 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7582 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7583 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
7584 entire symbol table available.
7585
7586 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7587 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7588 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7589 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7590 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7591 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7592 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7593 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7594
7595 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
7596 file has all the symbol information for your program.
7597
7598 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
7599 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
7600 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
7601 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
7602 needed.
7603
7604 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
7605 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
7606 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
7607
7608 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
7609 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
7610 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
7611 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
7612 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
7613 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
7614 @c files.
7615
7616 @kindex core
7617 @kindex core-file
7618 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7619 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
7620 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
7621 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
7622 executable file itself for other parts.
7623
7624 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
7625 to be used.
7626
7627 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7628 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
7629 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
7630 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
7631 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
7632
7633 @kindex add-symbol-file
7634 @cindex dynamic linking
7635 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
7636 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7637 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table information
7638 from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command when @var{filename}
7639 has been dynamically loaded (by some other means) into the program that
7640 is running. @var{address} should be the memory address at which the
7641 file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure this out for itself.
7642 You can specify @var{address} as an expression.
7643
7644 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
7645 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
7646 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data thus
7647 read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data instead,
7648 use the @code{symbol-file} command.
7649
7650 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7651
7652 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
7653 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
7654 table information for @var{filename}.
7655
7656 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
7657 @item add-shared-symbol-file
7658 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
7659 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
7660 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
7661 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
7662
7663 @kindex section
7664 @item section
7665 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
7666 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
7667 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
7668 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
7669 separately. The ``info files'' command lists all the sections and their
7670 addresses.
7671
7672 @kindex info files
7673 @kindex info target
7674 @item info files
7675 @itemx info target
7676 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
7677 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
7678 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
7679 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
7680 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
7681 current ones.
7682
7683 @end table
7684
7685 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
7686 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
7687 name and remembers it that way.
7688
7689 @cindex shared libraries
7690 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
7691 libraries.
7692
7693 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
7694 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
7695 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
7696 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
7697 debugging a core file).
7698
7699 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
7700 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
7701
7702 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
7703 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
7704 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
7705
7706 @table @code
7707 @kindex info sharedlibrary
7708 @kindex info share
7709 @item info share
7710 @itemx info sharedlibrary
7711 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
7712
7713 @kindex sharedlibrary
7714 @kindex share
7715 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
7716 @itemx share @var{regex}
7717
7718 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
7719 Unix regular expression.
7720 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
7721 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
7722 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
7723 loaded.
7724 @end table
7725
7726 On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
7727 and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
7728 a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
7729
7730 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
7731 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary}
7732 @var{filename}. The base address of the shared library is determined
7733 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
7734
7735 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
7736
7737 @table @code
7738 @kindex set auto-solib-add
7739 @item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
7740 Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
7741 nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
7742 automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
7743 linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
7744 the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
7745 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
7746 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
7747
7748 @kindex show auto-solib-add
7749 @item show auto-solib-add
7750 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
7751 @end table
7752
7753 @node Symbol Errors
7754 @section Errors reading symbol files
7755
7756 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
7757 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
7758 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
7759 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
7760 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
7761 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
7762 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
7763 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
7764 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
7765 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
7766 messages}).
7767
7768 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
7769
7770 @table @code
7771 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
7772
7773 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
7774 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
7775 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
7776 in its outer scope blocks.
7777
7778 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
7779 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
7780 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
7781 function.
7782
7783 @item block at @var{address} out of order
7784
7785 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
7786 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
7787 do so.
7788
7789 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
7790 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
7791 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
7792 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
7793 messages}.)
7794
7795 @item bad block start address patched
7796
7797 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
7798 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
7799 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
7800
7801 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
7802 starting on the previous source line.
7803
7804 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
7805
7806 @cindex foo
7807 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
7808 larger than the size of the string table.
7809
7810 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
7811 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
7812 with this name.
7813
7814 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
7815
7816 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
7817 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
7818 misunderstood information, in hexadecimal.
7819
7820 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
7821 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
7822 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7823 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
7824 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
7825 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
7826
7827 @item stub type has NULL name
7828
7829 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
7830
7831 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
7832 The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7833 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
7834 it.
7835
7836 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
7837
7838 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7839
7840 @end table
7841
7842 @node Targets
7843 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7844
7845 @cindex debugging target
7846 @kindex target
7847
7848 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
7849
7850 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
7851 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
7852 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
7853 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
7854 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
7855 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
7856 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
7857 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
7858
7859 @menu
7860 * Active Targets:: Active targets
7861 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
7862 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
7863 * Remote:: Remote debugging
7864 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
7865
7866 @end menu
7867
7868 @node Active Targets
7869 @section Active targets
7870
7871 @cindex stacking targets
7872 @cindex active targets
7873 @cindex multiple targets
7874
7875 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7876 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
7877 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
7878 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
7879 a core file.
7880
7881 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
7882 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
7883 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
7884 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
7885 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
7886 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
7887 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
7888 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
7889 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
7890
7891 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7892 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
7893 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
7894 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
7895 process target is active.
7896
7897 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
7898 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
7899 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7900 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
7901 process}).
7902
7903 @node Target Commands
7904 @section Commands for managing targets
7905
7906 @table @code
7907 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7908 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
7909 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
7910 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
7911 protocol of the target machine.
7912
7913 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
7914 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
7915 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
7916
7917 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
7918 after executing the command.
7919
7920 @kindex help target
7921 @item help target
7922 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
7923 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
7924 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7925
7926 @item help target @var{name}
7927 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
7928 select it.
7929
7930 @kindex set gnutarget
7931 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
7932 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
7933 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
7934 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
7935 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
7936 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
7937
7938 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
7939 you must know the actual BFD name.
7940
7941 @noindent @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
7942
7943 @kindex show gnutarget
7944 @item show gnutarget
7945 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
7946 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
7947 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
7948 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
7949 @end table
7950
7951 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
7952 configuration):
7953
7954 @table @code
7955 @kindex target exec
7956 @item target exec @var{program}
7957 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
7958 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
7959
7960 @kindex target core
7961 @item target core @var{filename}
7962 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
7963 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
7964
7965 @kindex target remote
7966 @item target remote @var{dev}
7967 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
7968 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
7969 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
7970 now supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
7971 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
7972 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
7973
7974 @kindex target sim
7975 @item target sim
7976 Builtin CPU simulator. GDB includes simulators for most architectures.
7977 In general,
7978 @example
7979 target sim
7980 load
7981 run
7982 @end example
7983 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
7984 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulator do
7985 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
7986 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
7987 Processors}.
7988
7989 @end table
7990
7991 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
7992
7993 @table @code
7994
7995 @kindex target nrom
7996 @item target nrom @var{dev}
7997 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
7998
7999 @end table
8000
8001 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
8002 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
8003
8004 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8005 once you've successfully established a connection.
8006
8007 @table @code
8008
8009 @kindex load @var{filename}
8010 @item load @var{filename}
8011 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8012 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8013 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8014 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8015 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8016 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8017
8018 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8019 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8020 target is @dots{}}''
8021
8022 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8023 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8024 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8025 specifies a fixed address.
8026 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8027
8028 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8029 @end table
8030
8031 @node Byte Order
8032 @section Choosing target byte order
8033
8034 @cindex choosing target byte order
8035 @cindex target byte order
8036 @kindex set endian big
8037 @kindex set endian little
8038 @kindex set endian auto
8039 @kindex show endian
8040
8041 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8042 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8043 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8044 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8045 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
8046 GDB's idea of processor endian-ness manually.
8047
8048 @table @code
8049 @kindex set endian big
8050 @item set endian big
8051 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8052
8053 @kindex set endian little
8054 @item set endian little
8055 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8056
8057 @kindex set endian auto
8058 @item set endian auto
8059 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8060 executable.
8061
8062 @item show endian
8063 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8064
8065 @end table
8066
8067 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8068 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8069 target system.
8070
8071 @node Remote
8072 @section Remote debugging
8073 @cindex remote debugging
8074
8075 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
8076 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8077 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
8078 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8079 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8080
8081 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8082 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
8083 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
8084 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8085 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8086 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8087
8088 Other remote targets may be available in your
8089 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
8090
8091 @menu
8092 * Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
8093 @end menu
8094
8095 @node Remote Serial
8096 @subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
8097
8098 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8099 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8100 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8101 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8102 program, you need:
8103
8104 @enumerate
8105 @item
8106 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8107 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8108 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
8109
8110 @item
8111 You probably need a C subroutine library to support your program's
8112 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
8113
8114 @item
8115 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8116 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8117 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8118 documentation.
8119 @end enumerate
8120
8121 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8122 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8123 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
8124
8125 @table @emph
8126 @item On the host,
8127 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8128 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8129 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8130
8131 @item On the target,
8132 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8133 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8134 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8135
8136 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8137 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8138 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8139 @end table
8140
8141 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8142 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8143 @sc{sparc} boards.
8144
8145 @cindex remote serial stub list
8146 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
8147
8148 @table @code
8149
8150 @item i386-stub.c
8151 @kindex i386-stub.c
8152 @cindex Intel
8153 @cindex i386
8154 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8155
8156 @item m68k-stub.c
8157 @kindex m68k-stub.c
8158 @cindex Motorola 680x0
8159 @cindex m680x0
8160 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8161
8162 @item sh-stub.c
8163 @kindex sh-stub.c
8164 @cindex Hitachi
8165 @cindex SH
8166 For Hitachi SH architectures.
8167
8168 @item sparc-stub.c
8169 @kindex sparc-stub.c
8170 @cindex Sparc
8171 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8172
8173 @item sparcl-stub.c
8174 @kindex sparcl-stub.c
8175 @cindex Fujitsu
8176 @cindex SparcLite
8177 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8178
8179 @end table
8180
8181 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8182 recently added stubs.
8183
8184 @menu
8185 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8186 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8187 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8188 * Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8189 * Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8190 * NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8191 @end menu
8192
8193 @node Stub Contents
8194 @subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8195
8196 @cindex remote serial stub
8197 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8198 subroutines:
8199
8200 @table @code
8201 @item set_debug_traps
8202 @kindex set_debug_traps
8203 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8204 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8205 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8206 beginning of your program.
8207
8208 @item handle_exception
8209 @kindex handle_exception
8210 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8211 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8212 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8213 run when a trap is triggered.
8214
8215 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8216 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8217 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8218 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
8219 representative on the target machine; it begins by sending summary
8220 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8221 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8222 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8223 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
8224 machine.
8225
8226 @item breakpoint
8227 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8228 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8229 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8230 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8231 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8232 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8233 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8234 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8235 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8236 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
8237 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
8238
8239 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8240 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8241 start of your debugging session.
8242 @end table
8243
8244 @node Bootstrapping
8245 @subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8246
8247 @cindex remote stub, support routines
8248 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8249 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8250 debugging target machine.
8251
8252 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8253 serial port.
8254
8255 @table @code
8256 @item int getDebugChar()
8257 @kindex getDebugChar
8258 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8259 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8260 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8261
8262 @item void putDebugChar(int)
8263 @kindex putDebugChar
8264 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
8265 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
8266 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8267 @end table
8268
8269 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
8270 @cindex interrupting remote targets
8271 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8272 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8273 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8274 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8275 remote system to stop.
8276
8277 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8278 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8279 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8280 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8281
8282 Other routines you need to supply are:
8283
8284 @table @code
8285 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8286 @kindex exceptionHandler
8287 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8288 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8289 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8290 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8291 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8292 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8293 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8294 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8295 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8296 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8297 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8298 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8299 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8300
8301 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8302 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8303 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8304 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8305 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8306
8307 @item void flush_i_cache()
8308 @kindex flush_i_cache
8309 (sparc and sparclite only) Write this subroutine to flush the
8310 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8311 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8312
8313 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8314 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8315 @end table
8316
8317 @noindent
8318 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8319
8320 @table @code
8321 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8322 @kindex memset
8323 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8324 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8325 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8326 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8327 @end table
8328
8329 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8330 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8331 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
8332 subroutines which @code{gcc} generates as inline code.
8333
8334
8335 @node Debug Session
8336 @subsubsection Putting it all together
8337
8338 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
8339 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8340 steps.
8341
8342 @enumerate
8343 @item
8344 Make sure you have the supporting low-level routines
8345 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8346 @display
8347 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8348 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8349 @end display
8350
8351 @item
8352 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8353
8354 @example
8355 set_debug_traps();
8356 breakpoint();
8357 @end example
8358
8359 @item
8360 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8361 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8362
8363 @example
8364 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8365 @end example
8366
8367 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
8368 function in your program, that function is called when
8369 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8370 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8371 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8372
8373 @item
8374 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8375 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8376
8377 @item
8378 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8379 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8380
8381 @item
8382 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8383 @c document that. FIXME.
8384 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8385 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8386
8387 @item
8388 To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8389 as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8390 This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8391 of its pure text.
8392
8393 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
8394 Then establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
8395 Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8396 machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8397 TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8398 to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8399 device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8400
8401 @example
8402 target remote /dev/ttyb
8403 @end example
8404
8405 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8406 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8407 @code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8408 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8409
8410 @example
8411 target remote manyfarms:2828
8412 @end example
8413 @end enumerate
8414
8415 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8416 step and continue the remote program.
8417
8418 To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8419 command.
8420
8421 @cindex interrupting remote programs
8422 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
8423 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8424 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8425 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8426 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8427 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8428
8429 @example
8430 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8431 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8432 @end example
8433
8434 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8435 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8436 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8437 goes back to waiting.
8438
8439 @node Protocol
8440 @subsubsection Communication protocol
8441
8442 @cindex debugging stub, example
8443 @cindex remote stub, example
8444 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
8445 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8446 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8447 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8448 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8449 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8450 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8451 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8452
8453 However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8454 the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8455 target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8456 it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8457
8458 In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8459 transmitted and received data respectfully.
8460
8461 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8462 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8463 @cindex remote serial protocol
8464 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments)
8465 are sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the
8466 character @samp{$}, this is followed by an optional two-digit
8467 @var{sequence-id} and the character @samp{:}, the actual
8468 @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character @samp{#} followed by a
8469 two-digit @var{checksum}:
8470
8471 @example
8472 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8473 @end example
8474 @noindent
8475 or, with the optional @var{sequence-id}:
8476 @example
8477 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8478 @end example
8479
8480 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8481 @noindent
8482 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
8483 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (that
8484 consisting of both the optional @var{sequence-id}@code{:} and the actual
8485 @var{packet-data}).
8486
8487 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8488 @noindent
8489 The two-digit @var{sequence-id}, when present, is returned with the
8490 acknowledgment. Beyond that its meaning is poorly defined.
8491 @value{GDBN} is not known to output @var{sequence-id}s.
8492
8493 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8494 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8495 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8496 retransmission):
8497
8498 @example
8499 <- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8500 -> @code{+}
8501 @end example
8502 @noindent
8503 If the received packet included a @var{sequence-id} than that is
8504 appended to a positive acknowledgment:
8505
8506 @example
8507 <- @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8508 -> @code{+}@var{sequence-id}
8509 @end example
8510
8511 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8512 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
8513 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8514 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8515
8516 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
8517 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for an
8518 exception). @samp{:} can not appear as the third character in a packet.
8519 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} and @samp{;}
8520 (unfortunately some packets chose to use @samp{:}). Except where
8521 otherwise noted all numbers are represented in HEX with leading zeros
8522 suppressed.
8523
8524 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
8525 means that the next character is an ASCII encoding giving a repeat count
8526 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8527 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
8528 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). Don't use an
8529 @code{n > 126}.
8530
8531 So:
8532 @example
8533 "@code{0* }"
8534 @end example
8535 @noindent
8536 means the same as "0000".
8537
8538 The error response, returned for some packets includes a two character
8539 error number. That number is not well defined.
8540
8541 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8542 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
8543 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
8544 on the response.
8545
8546 Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8547 their corresponding response @var{data}:
8548
8549 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8550 @item Packet
8551 @tab Request
8552 @tab Description
8553
8554 @item extended ops @emph{(optional)}
8555 @tab @code{!}
8556 @tab
8557 Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky -- only needs to be set once.
8558 The extended remote protocol support the @samp{R} packet.
8559 @item
8560 @tab reply @samp{}
8561 @tab
8562 Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8563 unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8564 support protocol extensions.
8565
8566 @item last signal
8567 @tab @code{?}
8568 @tab
8569 Reply the current reason for stopping. This is the same reply as is
8570 generated for step or cont : @code{S}@var{AA} where @var{AA} is the
8571 signal number.
8572
8573 @item reserved
8574 @tab @code{a}
8575 @tab Reserved for future use
8576
8577 @item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8578 @tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8579 @tab
8580 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
8581 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
8582 @item
8583 @tab reply @code{OK}
8584 @item
8585 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8586
8587 @item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
8588 @tab @code{b}@var{baud}
8589 @tab
8590 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
8591 transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
8592 transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
8593 acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
8594 to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
8595 ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
8596 specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
8597 that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
8598 happened.}
8599
8600 @item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
8601 @tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
8602 @tab
8603 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
8604 breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
8605 @samp{z} packets.}
8606
8607 @item continue
8608 @tab @code{c}@var{addr}
8609 @tab
8610 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8611 current address.
8612 @item
8613 @tab reply
8614 @tab see below
8615
8616 @item continue with signal @emph{(optional)}
8617 @tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
8618 @tab
8619 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
8620 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
8621 @item
8622 @tab reply
8623 @tab see below
8624
8625 @item toggle debug @emph{(optional)}
8626 @tab @code{d}
8627 @tab
8628 toggle debug flag (see 386 & 68k stubs)
8629
8630 @item detach @emph{(optional)}
8631 @tab @code{D}
8632 @tab Reply OK.
8633
8634 @item reserved
8635 @tab @code{e}
8636 @tab Reserved for future use
8637
8638 @item reserved
8639 @tab @code{E}
8640 @tab Reserved for future use
8641
8642 @item reserved
8643 @tab @code{f}
8644 @tab Reserved for future use
8645
8646 @item reserved
8647 @tab @code{F}
8648 @tab Reserved for future use
8649
8650 @item read registers
8651 @tab @code{g}
8652 @tab Read general registers.
8653 @item
8654 @tab reply @var{XX...}
8655 @tab
8656 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
8657 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
8658 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} is
8659 determined by the @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @var{REGISTER_NAME}
8660 macros.
8661 @item
8662 @tab @code{E}@var{NN}
8663 @tab for an error.
8664
8665 @item write regs
8666 @tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
8667 @tab
8668 See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
8669 @item
8670 @tab reply @code{OK}
8671 @tab for success
8672 @item
8673 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8674 @tab for an error
8675
8676 @item reserved
8677 @tab @code{h}
8678 @tab Reserved for future use
8679
8680 @item set thread @emph{(optional)}
8681 @tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
8682 @tab
8683 Set thread for subsequent operations. @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread
8684 used in step and continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads.
8685 @var{c} = @samp{g} for thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a
8686 thread, any thread.
8687 @item
8688 @tab reply @code{OK}
8689 @tab for success
8690 @item
8691 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8692 @tab for an error
8693
8694 @item cycle step @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
8695 @tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
8696 @tab
8697 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
8698 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
8699 step starting at that address.
8700
8701 @item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8702 @tab @code{I}
8703 @tab
8704 See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
8705
8706 @item reserved
8707 @tab @code{j}
8708 @tab Reserved for future use
8709
8710 @item reserved
8711 @tab @code{J}
8712 @tab Reserved for future use
8713
8714 @item kill request @emph{(optional)}
8715 @tab @code{k}
8716 @tab
8717
8718 @item reserved
8719 @tab @code{l}
8720 @tab Reserved for future use
8721
8722 @item reserved
8723 @tab @code{L}
8724 @tab Reserved for future use
8725
8726 @item read memory
8727 @tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
8728 @tab
8729 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
8730 @item
8731 @tab reply @var{XX...}
8732 @tab
8733 @var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able to
8734 read only part of the data.
8735 @item
8736 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8737 @tab @var{NN} is errno
8738
8739 @item write mem
8740 @tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
8741 @tab
8742 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
8743 @var{XX...} is the data.
8744 @item
8745 @tab reply @code{OK}
8746 @tab for success
8747 @item
8748 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8749 @tab
8750 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
8751 written).
8752
8753 @item reserved
8754 @tab @code{n}
8755 @tab Reserved for future use
8756
8757 @item reserved
8758 @tab @code{N}
8759 @tab Reserved for future use
8760
8761 @item reserved
8762 @tab @code{o}
8763 @tab Reserved for future use
8764
8765 @item reserved
8766 @tab @code{O}
8767 @tab Reserved for future use
8768
8769 @item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
8770 @tab @code{p}@var{n...}
8771 @tab
8772 See write register.
8773 @item
8774 @tab return @var{r....}
8775 @tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
8776
8777 @item write reg @emph{(optional)}
8778 @tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
8779 @tab
8780 Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
8781 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
8782 @item
8783 @tab reply @code{OK}
8784 @tab for success
8785 @item
8786 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8787 @tab for an error
8788
8789 @item general query @emph{(optional)}
8790 @tab @code{q}@var{query}
8791 @tab
8792 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} @var{query}'s
8793 have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
8794 leading lower case letter and a company prefix, ex: @samp{qfsf.var}.
8795 @var{query} may optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;}
8796 separated list. Stubs should ensure that they fully match any
8797 @var{query} name.
8798 @item
8799 @tab reply @code{XX...}
8800 @tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
8801 @item
8802 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8803 @tab error reply
8804 @item
8805 @tab reply @samp{}
8806 @tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
8807
8808 @item current thread
8809 @tab @code{q}@code{C}
8810 @tab Return the current thread id.
8811 @item
8812 @tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
8813 @tab
8814 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
8815 @item
8816 @tab reply *
8817 @tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
8818
8819 @item compute CRC of memory block
8820 @tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
8821 @tab
8822 @item
8823 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8824 @tab An error (such as memory fault)
8825 @item
8826 @tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
8827 @tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
8828
8829 @item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST}
8830 @tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
8831 @tab
8832 Obtain thread information from RTOS. @var{startflag} is one hex digit;
8833 @var{threadcount} is two hex digits; and @var{nextthread} is 16 hex
8834 digits.
8835 @item
8836 @tab reply *
8837 @tab
8838 See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
8839
8840 @item query sect offs
8841 @tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
8842 @tab Get section offsets.
8843 @item
8844 @tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
8845
8846 @item thread info request
8847 @tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
8848 @tab
8849 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
8850 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
8851 @item
8852 @tab reply *
8853 @tab
8854 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
8855
8856 @item remote command
8857 @tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
8858 @tab
8859 @var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8860 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
8861 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
8862 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
8863 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
8864 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
8865 @item
8866 @tab reply @code{OK}
8867 @tab
8868 A command response with no output.
8869 @item
8870 @tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
8871 @tab
8872 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
8873 @item
8874 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8875 @tab
8876 Indicate a badly formed request.
8877
8878 @item
8879 @tab reply @samp{}
8880 @tab
8881 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
8882
8883 @item general set @emph{(optional)}
8884 @tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
8885 @tab
8886 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
8887 naming conventions.
8888
8889 @item reset @emph{(optional)}
8890 @tab r
8891 @tab reset -- see sparc stub.
8892
8893 @item remote restart @emph{(optional)}
8894 @tab @code{R}@var{XX}
8895 @tab
8896 Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
8897 definition.
8898
8899 @item step @emph{(optional)}
8900 @tab @code{s}@var{addr}
8901 @tab
8902 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8903 same address.
8904 @item
8905 @tab reply
8906 @tab see below
8907
8908 @item step with signal @emph{(optional)}
8909 @tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
8910 @tab
8911 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
8912 @item
8913 @tab reply
8914 @tab see below
8915
8916 @item search @emph{(optional)}
8917 @tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
8918 @tab
8919 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
8920 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
8921 bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
8922
8923 @item thread alive @emph{(optional)}
8924 @tab @code{T}@var{XX}
8925 @tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
8926 @item
8927 @tab reply @code{OK}
8928 @tab thread is still alive
8929 @item
8930 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8931 @tab thread is dead
8932
8933 @item reserved
8934 @tab @code{u}
8935 @tab Reserved for future use
8936
8937 @item reserved
8938 @tab @code{U}
8939 @tab Reserved for future use
8940
8941 @item reserved
8942 @tab @code{v}
8943 @tab Reserved for future use
8944
8945 @item reserved
8946 @tab @code{V}
8947 @tab Reserved for future use
8948
8949 @item reserved
8950 @tab @code{w}
8951 @tab Reserved for future use
8952
8953 @item reserved
8954 @tab @code{W}
8955 @tab Reserved for future use
8956
8957 @item reserved
8958 @tab @code{x}
8959 @tab Reserved for future use
8960
8961 @item write mem (binary) @emph{(optional)}
8962 @tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
8963 @tab
8964 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
8965 binary data.
8966 @item
8967 @tab reply @code{OK}
8968 @tab for success
8969 @item
8970 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8971 @tab for an error
8972
8973 @item reserved
8974 @tab @code{y}
8975 @tab Reserved for future use
8976
8977 @item reserved
8978 @tab @code{Y}
8979 @tab Reserved for future use
8980
8981 @item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
8982 @tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
8983 @tab
8984 See @samp{Z}.
8985
8986 @item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
8987 @tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
8988 @tab
8989 @var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
8990 breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
8991 @samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
8992 bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
8993 the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
8994 @var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored.
8995 @item
8996 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8997 @tab for an error
8998 @item
8999 @tab reply @code{OK}
9000 @tab for success
9001 @item
9002 @tab @samp{}
9003 @tab If not supported.
9004
9005 @item reserved
9006 @tab <other>
9007 @tab Reserved for future use
9008
9009 @end multitable
9010
9011 In the case of the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets,
9012 there is no immediate response. The reply, described below, comes when
9013 the machine stops:
9014
9015 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9016
9017 @item @code{S}@var{AA}
9018 @tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9019
9020 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9021 @tab
9022 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9023 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9024 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9025 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
9026 starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
9027 @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9028 extend the protocol.
9029
9030 @item @code{W}@var{AA}
9031 @tab
9032 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9033 applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9034
9035 @item @code{X}@var{AA}
9036 @tab
9037 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9038
9039 @item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{tttttttt}@code{;}@var{dddddddd}@code{;}@var{bbbbbbbb} @strong{(obsolete)}
9040 @tab
9041 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{tttttttt} = address of symbol "_start";
9042 @var{dddddddd} = base of data section; @var{bbbbbbbb} = base of bss
9043 section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference
9044 between this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may
9045 arrive spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the
9046 host debugger.}
9047
9048 @item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9049 @tab
9050 @var{XX...} is hex encoding of ASCII data. This can happen at any time
9051 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9052 for 'W', 'T', etc.
9053
9054 @end multitable
9055
9056 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9057 does not get any direct output:
9058
9059 @example
9060 <- @code{R00}
9061 -> @code{+}
9062 @emph{target restarts}
9063 <- @code{?}
9064 -> @code{+}
9065 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9066 <- @code{+}
9067 @end example
9068
9069 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9070
9071 @example
9072 <- @code{G1445...}
9073 -> @code{+}
9074 <- @code{s}
9075 -> @code{+}
9076 @emph{time passes}
9077 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9078 <- @code{+}
9079 <- @code{g}
9080 -> @code{+}
9081 -> @code{1455...}
9082 <- @code{+}
9083 @end example
9084
9085 @kindex set remotedebug
9086 @kindex show remotedebug
9087 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
9088 @cindex serial connections, debugging
9089 If you have trouble with the serial connection, you can use the command
9090 @code{set remotedebug}. This makes @value{GDBN} report on all packets sent
9091 back and forth across the serial line to the remote machine. The
9092 packet-debugging information is printed on the @value{GDBN} standard output
9093 stream. @code{set remotedebug off} turns it off, and @code{show
9094 remotedebug} shows you its current state.
9095
9096 @node Server
9097 @subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9098
9099 @kindex gdbserver
9100 @cindex remote connection without stubs
9101 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9102 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9103 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9104
9105 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9106 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9107 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9108 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9109 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9110 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9111 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9112 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9113 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9114 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9115 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9116 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9117 choice for debugging.
9118
9119 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9120 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9121 protocol.
9122
9123 @table @emph
9124 @item On the target machine,
9125 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9126 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9127 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9128 system does all the symbol handling.
9129
9130 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9131 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9132 syntax is:
9133
9134 @smallexample
9135 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9136 @end smallexample
9137
9138 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9139 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9140 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9141 @file{/dev/com1}:
9142
9143 @smallexample
9144 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9145 @end smallexample
9146
9147 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9148 with it.
9149
9150 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9151
9152 @smallexample
9153 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9154 @end smallexample
9155
9156 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9157 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9158 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9159 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9160 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9161 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9162 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9163 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9164 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
9165 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
9166 @code{target remote} command.
9167
9168 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9169 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9170 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9171 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9172 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9173 running at anything other than 9600 bps.) After that, use @code{target
9174 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9175 is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9176 @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9177 @code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9178
9179 @smallexample
9180 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9181 @end smallexample
9182
9183 @noindent
9184 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9185
9186 @smallexample
9187 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9188 @end smallexample
9189
9190 @noindent
9191 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9192 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9193 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9194 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9195 @samp{Connection refused}.
9196 @end table
9197
9198 @node NetWare
9199 @subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9200
9201 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
9202 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9203 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9204 @code{target remote}.
9205
9206 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9207 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9208
9209 @table @emph
9210 @item On the target machine,
9211 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9212 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9213 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9214 host system does all the symbol handling.
9215
9216 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9217 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9218 program. The syntax is:
9219
9220 @smallexample
9221 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9222 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9223 @end smallexample
9224
9225 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9226 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
9227 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600 bps.
9228
9229 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
9230 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
9231 using a 19200 bps connection:
9232
9233 @smallexample
9234 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9235 @end smallexample
9236
9237 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9238 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9239 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9240 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9241 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9242 running at anything other than 9600 bps. After that, use @code{target
9243 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9244 argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9245 @file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9246
9247 @smallexample
9248 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9249 @end smallexample
9250
9251 @noindent
9252 communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9253 @end table
9254
9255 @node KOD
9256 @section Kernel Object Display
9257
9258 @cindex kernel object display
9259 @cindex kernel object
9260 @cindex KOD
9261
9262 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9263 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9264 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9265 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9266 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9267
9268 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9269 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9270
9271 @example
9272 (gdb) set os cisco
9273 @end example
9274
9275 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9276 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9277 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9278 after the operating system:
9279
9280 @example
9281 (gdb) info cisco
9282 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9283 Object Description
9284 any Any and all objects
9285 @end example
9286
9287 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9288 by the kernel.
9289
9290 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
9291 is supported other than to try it.
9292
9293
9294 @node Configurations
9295 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9296
9297 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9298 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9299 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9300
9301 There are three major categories of configurations: native
9302 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9303 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9304 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9305 are quite different from each other.
9306
9307 @menu
9308 * Native::
9309 * Embedded OS::
9310 * Embedded Processors::
9311 * Architectures::
9312 @end menu
9313
9314 @node Native
9315 @section Native
9316
9317 This section describes details specific to particular native
9318 configurations.
9319
9320 @menu
9321 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
9322 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9323 @end menu
9324
9325 @node HP-UX
9326 @subsection HP-UX
9327
9328 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9329 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9330 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9331
9332 @node SVR4 Process Information
9333 @subsection SVR4 process information
9334
9335 @kindex /proc
9336 @cindex process image
9337
9338 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9339 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9340 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9341 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9342 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9343 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9344 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9345 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9346
9347 @table @code
9348 @kindex info proc
9349 @item info proc
9350 Summarize available information about the process.
9351
9352 @kindex info proc mappings
9353 @item info proc mappings
9354 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9355 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9356
9357 @kindex info proc times
9358 @item info proc times
9359 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9360 its children.
9361
9362 @kindex info proc id
9363 @item info proc id
9364 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9365 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9366
9367 @kindex info proc status
9368 @item info proc status
9369 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
9370 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9371 received.
9372
9373 @item info proc all
9374 Show all the above information about the process.
9375 @end table
9376
9377 @node Embedded OS
9378 @section Embedded Operating Systems
9379
9380 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9381 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9382 architectures.
9383
9384 @menu
9385 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9386 @end menu
9387
9388 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9389 various real-time operating systems.
9390
9391 @node VxWorks
9392 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9393
9394 @cindex VxWorks
9395
9396 @table @code
9397
9398 @kindex target vxworks
9399 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9400 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
9401 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9402
9403 @end table
9404
9405 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9406 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9407
9408 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9409 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
9410 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9411 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
9412 @code{gdb} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
9413 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
9414 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
9415
9416 @table @code
9417 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9418 @kindex vxworks-timeout
9419 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9420 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
9421 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
9422 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
9423 of a thin network line.
9424 @end table
9425
9426 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9427 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9428 procedures.
9429
9430 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9431 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9432 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9433 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9434 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9435 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9436 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
9437 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9438 manual.
9439 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9440
9441 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
9442 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
9443 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{gdb} (or @code{vxgdb},
9444 depending on your installation).
9445
9446 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
9447
9448 @example
9449 (vxgdb)
9450 @end example
9451
9452 @menu
9453 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
9454 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
9455 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
9456 @end menu
9457
9458 @node VxWorks Connection
9459 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
9460
9461 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
9462 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
9463
9464 @example
9465 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
9466 @end example
9467
9468 @need 750
9469 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
9470
9471 @smallexample
9472 Attaching remote machine across net...
9473 Connected to tt.
9474 @end smallexample
9475
9476 @need 1000
9477 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
9478 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
9479 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
9480 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
9481 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
9482
9483 @example
9484 prog.o: No such file or directory.
9485 @end example
9486
9487 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
9488 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
9489 command again.
9490
9491 @node VxWorks Download
9492 @subsubsection VxWorks download
9493
9494 @cindex download to VxWorks
9495 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
9496 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
9497 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
9498 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
9499 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
9500 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
9501 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
9502 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
9503 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
9504 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
9505 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
9506 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
9507 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
9508 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
9509 program, type this on VxWorks:
9510
9511 @example
9512 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
9513 @end example
9514 v
9515 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
9516
9517 @example
9518 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
9519 (vxgdb) load prog.o
9520 @end example
9521
9522 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
9523
9524 @smallexample
9525 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
9526 @end smallexample
9527
9528 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
9529 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
9530 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
9531 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
9532 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
9533 debugger data structures that reference the target system's symbol
9534 table.)
9535
9536 @node VxWorks Attach
9537 @subsubsection Running tasks
9538
9539 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
9540 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
9541 follows:
9542
9543 @example
9544 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
9545 @end example
9546
9547 @noindent
9548 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
9549 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
9550 the time of attachment.
9551
9552 @node Embedded Processors
9553 @section Embedded Processors
9554
9555 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
9556 configurations.
9557
9558 @menu
9559 * A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
9560 * ARM:: ARM
9561 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
9562 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
9563 * i960:: Intel i960
9564 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
9565 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
9566 * M88K:: Motorola M88K
9567 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
9568 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
9569 * PowerPC: PowerPC
9570 * SH:: Hitachi SH
9571 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
9572 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
9573 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
9574 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
9575 @end menu
9576
9577 @node A29K Embedded
9578 @subsection AMD A29K Embedded
9579
9580 @menu
9581 * A29K UDI::
9582 * A29K EB29K::
9583 * Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
9584 * gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
9585 * Remote Log:: Remote log
9586 @end menu
9587
9588 @table @code
9589
9590 @kindex target adapt
9591 @item target adapt @var{dev}
9592 Adapt monitor for A29K.
9593
9594 @kindex target amd-eb
9595 @item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
9596 @cindex AMD EB29K
9597 Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
9598 @var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
9599 @var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
9600 name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
9601 @xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
9602
9603 @end table
9604
9605 @node A29K UDI
9606 @subsubsection A29K UDI
9607
9608 @cindex UDI
9609 @cindex AMD29K via UDI
9610
9611 @value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
9612 protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
9613 configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
9614 program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
9615 use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
9616 @code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
9617
9618 @table @code
9619 @item target udi @var{keyword}
9620 @kindex udi
9621 Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
9622 @var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
9623 This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
9624 connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
9625 working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
9626 to its pathname.
9627 @end table
9628
9629 @node A29K EB29K
9630 @subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
9631
9632 @cindex EB29K board
9633 @cindex running 29K programs
9634
9635 AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
9636 with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
9637 term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
9638 @value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
9639 must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
9640 board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
9641 assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
9642 @file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
9643
9644 @node Comms (EB29K)
9645 @subsubsection Communications setup
9646
9647 The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
9648 in DOS on the PC:
9649
9650 @example
9651 C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
9652 @end example
9653
9654 @noindent
9655 This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
9656 bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
9657 you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
9658 end of the connection as well.
9659 @c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
9660 @c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
9661
9662 To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
9663 the following at the DOS console:
9664
9665 @example
9666 C:\> CTTY com1
9667 @end example
9668
9669 @noindent
9670 (Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
9671 the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
9672 had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line).
9673
9674 From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
9675 @code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
9676
9677 @example
9678 cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
9679 @end example
9680
9681 @noindent
9682 The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
9683 serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
9684 may look something like the following:
9685
9686 @example
9687 tip -9600 /dev/ttya
9688 @end example
9689
9690 @noindent
9691 Your system may require a different name where we show
9692 @file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
9693 parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
9694 @code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
9695 system table @file{/etc/remote}.
9696 @c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
9697 @c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
9698 @c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
9699 @c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
9700 @c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
9701 @c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
9702 @c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
9703
9704 @kindex EBMON
9705 Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
9706 directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
9707 start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
9708 with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
9709 @code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
9710 @code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
9711
9712 @example
9713 C:\> G:
9714
9715 G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
9716
9717 G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
9718 Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
9719 Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
9720 Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
9721
9722 Enter '?' or 'H' for help
9723
9724 PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
9725 I/O Base = 0x208
9726 Memory Base = 0xd0000
9727
9728 Data Memory Size = 2048KB
9729 Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
9730 Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
9731
9732 PageSize = 0x400
9733 Register Stack Size = 0x800
9734 Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
9735
9736 CPU PRL = 0x3
9737 Am29027 Available = No
9738 Byte Write Available = Yes
9739
9740 # ~.
9741 @end example
9742
9743 Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
9744 typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
9745 running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
9746
9747 For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
9748 way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
9749 system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @code{G:}'' on the
9750 PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
9751 something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
9752 other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
9753 from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
9754 serial line.
9755
9756 @node gdb-EB29K
9757 @subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
9758
9759 Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
9760 program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
9761 name of your 29K program:
9762
9763 @example
9764 cd /usr/joe/work29k
9765 @value{GDBP} myfoo
9766 @end example
9767
9768 @need 500
9769 Now you can use the @code{target} command:
9770
9771 @example
9772 target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
9773 @c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
9774 @c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
9775 @c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
9776 @end example
9777
9778 @noindent
9779 In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
9780 @file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
9781 @code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
9782 In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
9783 a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
9784 the name on the Unix side.
9785
9786 At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
9787 to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
9788 @code{run}.
9789
9790 To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
9791 command.
9792
9793 To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
9794 once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
9795 @code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
9796 @code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
9797 Type @code{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
9798 and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
9799
9800 @node Remote Log
9801 @subsubsection Remote log
9802 @kindex eb.log
9803 @cindex log file for EB29K
9804
9805 The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
9806 current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
9807 @file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
9808 of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
9809 another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
9810 unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
9811
9812 @node ARM
9813 @subsection ARM
9814
9815 @table @code
9816
9817 @kindex target rdi
9818 @item target rdi @var{dev}
9819 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
9820 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
9821 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
9822
9823 @kindex target rdp
9824 @item target rdp @var{dev}
9825 ARM Demon monitor.
9826
9827 @end table
9828
9829 @node H8/300
9830 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
9831
9832 @table @code
9833
9834 @kindex target hms
9835 @item target hms @var{dev}
9836 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
9837 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
9838 line and the communications speed used.
9839
9840 @kindex target e7000
9841 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
9842 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
9843
9844 @kindex target sh3
9845 @kindex target sh3e
9846 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
9847 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
9848 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
9849
9850 @end table
9851
9852 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
9853 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
9854 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
9855 @cindex Hitachi SH download
9856 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
9857 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
9858 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
9859 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
9860
9861 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
9862 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
9863
9864 @enumerate
9865 @item
9866 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
9867 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
9868 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
9869 the default when GDB is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
9870 H8/300, or H8/500.)
9871
9872 @item
9873 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
9874 serial device available on your host is the default).
9875
9876 @item
9877 what speed to use over the serial device.
9878 @end enumerate
9879
9880 @menu
9881 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
9882 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
9883 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
9884 @end menu
9885
9886 @node Hitachi Boards
9887 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
9888
9889 @c only for Unix hosts
9890 @kindex device
9891 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
9892 Use the special @code{@value{GDBP}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
9893 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
9894 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
9895 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
9896
9897 @kindex speed
9898 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
9899 @code{@value{GDBP}} has another special command to set the communications
9900 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
9901 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside GDB with
9902 the DOS @kbd{mode} command (for instance, @w{@samp{mode
9903 com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600 bps connection).
9904
9905 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
9906 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
9907 use a DOS host,
9908 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
9909 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
9910 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
9911 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
9912
9913 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
9914 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
9915 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
9916 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
9917
9918 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
9919 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
9920 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
9921 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
9922 degugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
9923 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
9924 @code{COM2}.
9925
9926 @example
9927 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
9928 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
9929
9930 Resident portion of MODE loaded
9931
9932 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
9933
9934 @end example
9935
9936 @quotation
9937 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
9938 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
9939 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
9940 your development board.
9941 @end quotation
9942
9943 @kindex target hms
9944 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
9945 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
9946 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBP}} prompts
9947 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
9948 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
9949 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
9950 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
9951 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
9952 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
9953 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
9954 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
9955 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
9956
9957 @smallexample
9958 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
9959 GDB is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
9960 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
9961 the conditions.
9962 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB; type "show warranty"
9963 for details.
9964 GDB @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
9965 (gdb) target hms
9966 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
9967 (gdb) load t.x
9968 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
9969 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
9970 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
9971 @end smallexample
9972
9973 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
9974 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
9975 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
9976 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
9977 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
9978 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
9979
9980 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
9981 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
9982 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
9983
9984 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
9985 @itemize @bullet
9986 @item
9987 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
9988 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
9989
9990 @item
9991 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
9992 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
9993 to detect program completion.
9994 @end itemize
9995
9996 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
9997 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
9998
9999 @node Hitachi ICE
10000 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10001
10002 @kindex target e7000
10003 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10004 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10005 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10006
10007 @table @code
10008 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10009 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10010 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10011 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10012 (for example, @samp{9600}).
10013
10014 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10015 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10016 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10017 @end table
10018
10019 @node Hitachi Special
10020 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10021
10022 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10023
10024 @table @code
10025
10026 @kindex set machine
10027 @kindex show machine
10028 @item set machine h8300
10029 @itemx set machine h8300h
10030 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10031 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10032 to check which variant is currently in effect.
10033
10034 @end table
10035
10036 @node H8/500
10037 @subsection H8/500
10038
10039 @table @code
10040
10041 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
10042 @cindex memory models, H8/500
10043 @item set memory @var{mod}
10044 @itemx show memory
10045 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10046 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10047 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10048 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10049
10050 @end table
10051
10052 @node i960
10053 @subsection Intel i960
10054
10055 @table @code
10056
10057 @kindex target mon960
10058 @item target mon960 @var{dev}
10059 MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10060
10061 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
10062 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10063 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10064 @file{/dev/ttya}.
10065
10066 @end table
10067
10068 @cindex Nindy
10069 @cindex i960
10070 @dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10071 @value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10072 tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10073
10074 @itemize @bullet
10075 @item
10076 Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10077 Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10078
10079 @item
10080 By responding to a prompt on startup;
10081
10082 @item
10083 By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10084 session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10085
10086 @kindex target nindy
10087 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
10088 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10089 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10090 @file{/dev/ttya}.
10091
10092 @end itemize
10093
10094 @cindex download to Nindy-960
10095 With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10096 downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10097 @value{GDBN}.
10098
10099 @menu
10100 * Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10101 * Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10102 * Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10103 @end menu
10104
10105 @node Nindy Startup
10106 @subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10107
10108 If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10109 options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10110 reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10111
10112 @example
10113 Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
10114 @end example
10115
10116 @noindent
10117 Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10118 identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10119 simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10120 with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10121 use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10122
10123 @node Nindy Options
10124 @subsubsection Options for Nindy
10125
10126 These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10127 Nindy-960 board attached:
10128
10129 @table @code
10130 @item -r @var{port}
10131 Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10132 to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10133 configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10134 @var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10135 device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10136 suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10137
10138 @item -O
10139 (An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10140 the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10141 This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10142 target architecture.
10143
10144 @quotation
10145 @emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10146 connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10147 fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10148 attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10149 this process with an interrupt.
10150 @end quotation
10151
10152 @item -brk
10153 Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10154 system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10155
10156 @quotation
10157 @emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10158 requires; it only works with a few boards.
10159 @end quotation
10160 @end table
10161
10162 The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10163 port.
10164
10165 @c @group
10166 @node Nindy Reset
10167 @subsubsection Nindy reset command
10168
10169 @table @code
10170 @item reset
10171 @kindex reset
10172 For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10173 system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10174 circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10175 a break is detected.
10176 @end table
10177 @c @end group
10178
10179 @node M32R/D
10180 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10181
10182 @table @code
10183
10184 @kindex target m32r
10185 @item target m32r @var{dev}
10186 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10187
10188 @end table
10189
10190 @node M68K
10191 @subsection M68k
10192
10193 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10194 target command for the following ROM monitors.
10195
10196 @table @code
10197
10198 @kindex target abug
10199 @item target abug @var{dev}
10200 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10201
10202 @kindex target cpu32bug
10203 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10204 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10205
10206 @kindex target dbug
10207 @item target dbug @var{dev}
10208 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10209
10210 @kindex target est
10211 @item target est @var{dev}
10212 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10213
10214 @kindex target rom68k
10215 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
10216 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10217
10218 @end table
10219
10220 If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10221 instead have only a single special target command:
10222
10223 @table @code
10224
10225 @kindex target es1800
10226 @item target es1800 @var{dev}
10227 ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10228
10229 @end table
10230
10231 [context?]
10232
10233 @table @code
10234
10235 @kindex target rombug
10236 @item target rombug @var{dev}
10237 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10238
10239 @end table
10240
10241 @node M88K
10242 @subsection M88K
10243
10244 @table @code
10245
10246 @kindex target bug
10247 @item target bug @var{dev}
10248 BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10249
10250 @end table
10251
10252 @node MIPS Embedded
10253 @subsection MIPS Embedded
10254
10255 @cindex MIPS boards
10256 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10257 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10258 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10259
10260 @need 1000
10261 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10262
10263 @table @code
10264 @item target mips @var{port}
10265 @kindex target mips @var{port}
10266 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10267 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10268 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10269 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10270 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10271 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10272
10273 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10274 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10275 debugger:
10276
10277 @example
10278 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
10279 GDB is free software and @dots{}
10280 (gdb) target mips /dev/ttyb
10281 (gdb) load @var{prog}
10282 (gdb) run
10283 @end example
10284
10285 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10286 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10287 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10288 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10289 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10290
10291 @item target pmon @var{port}
10292 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
10293 PMON ROM monitor.
10294
10295 @item target ddb @var{port}
10296 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
10297 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10298
10299 @item target lsi @var{port}
10300 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
10301 LSI variant of PMON.
10302
10303 @kindex target r3900
10304 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
10305 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10306
10307 @kindex target array
10308 @item target array @var{dev}
10309 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10310
10311 @end table
10312
10313
10314 @noindent
10315 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10316
10317 @table @code
10318 @item set processor @var{args}
10319 @itemx show processor
10320 @kindex set processor @var{args}
10321 @kindex show processor
10322 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10323 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
10324 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
10325 to use the CPO registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
10326 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
10327 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
10328 @value{GDBN} is using.
10329
10330 @item set mipsfpu double
10331 @itemx set mipsfpu single
10332 @itemx set mipsfpu none
10333 @itemx show mipsfpu
10334 @kindex set mipsfpu
10335 @kindex show mipsfpu
10336 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
10337 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10338 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10339 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
10340 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBINIT}
10341 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10342 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
10343 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10344 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10345 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10346 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
10347 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10348 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10349
10350 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10351 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10352 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10353
10354 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10355 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
10356
10357 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
10358 @itemx show remotedebug
10359 @kindex set remotedebug
10360 @kindex show remotedebug
10361 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10362 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10363 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10364 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
10365 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10366 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
10367 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
10368 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
10369 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10370
10371 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
10372 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10373 @itemx show timeout
10374 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
10375 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10376 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10377 @kindex set timeout
10378 @kindex show timeout
10379 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
10380 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
10381 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10382 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
10383 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10384 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10385 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
10386 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10387 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10388 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10389
10390 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10391 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10392 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10393 to run before stopping.
10394 @end table
10395
10396 @node PowerPC
10397 @subsection PowerPC
10398
10399 @table @code
10400
10401 @kindex target dink32
10402 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
10403 DINK32 ROM monitor.
10404
10405 @kindex target ppcbug
10406 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10407 @kindex target ppcbug1
10408 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10409 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10410
10411 @kindex target sds
10412 @item target sds @var{dev}
10413 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10414
10415 @end table
10416
10417 @node PA
10418 @subsection HP PA Embedded
10419
10420 @table @code
10421
10422 @kindex target op50n
10423 @item target op50n @var{dev}
10424 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10425
10426 @kindex target w89k
10427 @item target w89k @var{dev}
10428 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10429
10430 @end table
10431
10432 @node SH
10433 @subsection Hitachi SH
10434
10435 @table @code
10436
10437 @kindex target hms
10438 @item target hms @var{dev}
10439 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
10440 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
10441 the communications speed used.
10442
10443 @kindex target e7000
10444 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
10445 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
10446
10447 @kindex target sh3
10448 @kindex target sh3e
10449 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
10450 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
10451 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10452
10453 @end table
10454
10455 @node Sparclet
10456 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
10457
10458 @cindex Sparclet
10459
10460 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
10461 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
10462 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10463 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
10464 @code{gdb} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
10465
10466 @table @code
10467 @item timeout @var{args}
10468 @kindex remotetimeout
10469 @value{GDBN} now supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
10470 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10471 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
10472 @end table
10473
10474 @kindex Compiling
10475 When compiling for debugging, include the options "-g" to get debug
10476 information and "-Ttext" to relocate the program to where you wish to
10477 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options "-n" or
10478 "-N" in order to reduce the size of the sections.
10479
10480 @example
10481 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
10482 @end example
10483
10484 You can use objdump to verify that the addresses are what you intended.
10485
10486 @example
10487 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
10488 @end example
10489
10490 @kindex Running
10491 Once you have set
10492 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
10493 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{gdb}
10494 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
10495
10496 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10497
10498 @example
10499 (gdbslet)
10500 @end example
10501
10502 @menu
10503 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
10504 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
10505 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
10506 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
10507 @end menu
10508
10509 @node Sparclet File
10510 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
10511
10512 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
10513
10514 @example
10515 (gdbslet) file prog
10516 @end example
10517
10518 @need 1000
10519 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
10520 @value{GDBN} locates
10521 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
10522 path.
10523 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
10524 files will be searched as well.
10525 @value{GDBN} locates
10526 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
10527 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
10528 If it fails
10529 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
10530
10531 @example
10532 prog: No such file or directory.
10533 @end example
10534
10535 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
10536 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
10537 @code{target} command again.
10538
10539 @node Sparclet Connection
10540 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
10541
10542 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
10543 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
10544
10545 @example
10546 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
10547 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
10548 main () at ../prog.c:3
10549 @end example
10550
10551 @need 750
10552 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10553
10554 @smallexample
10555 Connected to ttya.
10556 @end smallexample
10557
10558 @node Sparclet Download
10559 @subsubsection Sparclet download
10560
10561 @cindex download to Sparclet
10562 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
10563 you can use the @value{GDBN}
10564 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
10565 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
10566 command.
10567 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
10568 address. You can use objdump to find out what this value is. The load
10569 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
10570 of each of the file's sections.
10571 For instance, if the program
10572 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
10573 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10574
10575 @example
10576 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
10577 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
10578 @end example
10579
10580 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
10581 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
10582 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
10583
10584 @node Sparclet Execution
10585 @subsubsection Running and debugging
10586
10587 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
10588 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
10589 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
10590 manual for the list of commands.
10591
10592 @example
10593 (gdbslet) b main
10594 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
10595 (gdbslet) run
10596 Starting program: prog
10597 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
10598 3 char *symarg = 0;
10599 (gdbslet) step
10600 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
10601 (gdbslet)
10602 @end example
10603
10604 @node Sparclite
10605 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
10606
10607 @table @code
10608
10609 @kindex target sparclite
10610 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
10611 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
10612 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
10613 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
10614 remote protocol.
10615
10616 @end table
10617
10618 @node ST2000
10619 @subsection Tandem ST2000
10620
10621 GDB may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
10622 STDBUG protocol.
10623
10624 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
10625 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
10626
10627 @example
10628 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
10629 @end example
10630
10631 @noindent
10632 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
10633 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
10634 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
10635 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
10636 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10637
10638 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
10639 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
10640 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
10641 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
10642 available on your host computer.
10643 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
10644 @c basically hearsay.
10645
10646 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
10647 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
10648 environment:
10649
10650 @table @code
10651 @item st2000 @var{command}
10652 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
10653 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
10654 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
10655 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
10656 manual for available commands.
10657
10658 @item connect
10659 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
10660 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
10661 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
10662 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
10663 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
10664 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
10665 @end table
10666
10667 @node Z8000
10668 @subsection Zilog Z8000
10669
10670 @cindex Z8000
10671 @cindex simulator, Z8000
10672 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
10673
10674 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
10675 a Z8000 simulator.
10676
10677 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
10678 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
10679 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
10680 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
10681
10682 @table @code
10683 @item target sim @var{args}
10684 @kindex sim
10685 @kindex target sim
10686 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
10687 options, specify them via @var{args}.
10688 @end table
10689
10690 @noindent
10691 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
10692 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
10693 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
10694 to run your program, and so on.
10695
10696 As well as making available all the usual machine registers (see
10697 @code{info reg}), the Z8000 simulator provides three additional items
10698 of information as specially named registers:
10699
10700 @table @code
10701
10702 @item cycles
10703 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
10704
10705 @item insts
10706 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
10707
10708 @item time
10709 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
10710
10711 @end table
10712
10713 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
10714 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
10715 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
10716 simulated clock ticks.
10717
10718 @node Architectures
10719 @section Architectures
10720
10721 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
10722 all uses of GDB with this architecture, both native and cross.
10723
10724 @menu
10725 * A29K::
10726 * Alpha::
10727 * MIPS::
10728 @end menu
10729
10730 @node A29K
10731 @subsection A29K
10732
10733 @table @code
10734
10735 @kindex set rstack_high_address
10736 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
10737 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
10738 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
10739 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
10740 ``register stack''. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
10741 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
10742 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
10743 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
10744 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
10745 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
10746 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
10747 hexadecimal.
10748
10749 @kindex show rstack_high_address
10750 @item show rstack_high_address
10751 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
10752 processors.
10753
10754 @end table
10755
10756 @node Alpha
10757 @subsection Alpha
10758
10759 See the following section.
10760
10761 @node MIPS
10762 @subsection MIPS
10763
10764 @cindex stack on Alpha
10765 @cindex stack on MIPS
10766 @cindex Alpha stack
10767 @cindex MIPS stack
10768 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
10769 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
10770 find the beginning of a function.
10771
10772 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
10773 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
10774 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
10775 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
10776 commands:
10777
10778 @table @code
10779 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha,MIPS)
10780 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
10781 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
10782 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
10783 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
10784 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
10785 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
10786
10787 @item show heuristic-fence-post
10788 Display the current limit.
10789 @end table
10790
10791 @noindent
10792 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
10793 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
10794
10795
10796 @node Controlling GDB
10797 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
10798
10799 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
10800 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
10801 data, @pxref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}; other settings are
10802 described here.
10803
10804 @menu
10805 * Prompt:: Prompt
10806 * Editing:: Command editing
10807 * History:: Command history
10808 * Screen Size:: Screen size
10809 * Numbers:: Numbers
10810 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
10811 @end menu
10812
10813 @node Prompt
10814 @section Prompt
10815
10816 @cindex prompt
10817
10818 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
10819 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
10820 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
10821 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
10822 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
10823 which one you are talking to.
10824
10825 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} no longer adds a space for you after the
10826 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
10827 or a prompt that does not.
10828
10829 @table @code
10830 @kindex set prompt
10831 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
10832 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
10833
10834 @kindex show prompt
10835 @item show prompt
10836 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
10837 @end table
10838
10839 @node Editing
10840 @section Command editing
10841 @cindex readline
10842 @cindex command line editing
10843
10844 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
10845 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
10846 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
10847 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
10848 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
10849 debugging sessions.
10850
10851 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
10852 command @code{set}.
10853
10854 @table @code
10855 @kindex set editing
10856 @cindex editing
10857 @item set editing
10858 @itemx set editing on
10859 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
10860
10861 @item set editing off
10862 Disable command line editing.
10863
10864 @kindex show editing
10865 @item show editing
10866 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
10867 @end table
10868
10869 @node History
10870 @section Command history
10871
10872 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
10873 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
10874 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
10875 history facility.
10876
10877 @table @code
10878 @cindex history substitution
10879 @cindex history file
10880 @kindex set history filename
10881 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
10882 @item set history filename @var{fname}
10883 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
10884 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
10885 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
10886 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
10887 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
10888 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
10889 @file{./.gdb_history} if this variable is not set.
10890
10891 @cindex history save
10892 @kindex set history save
10893 @item set history save
10894 @itemx set history save on
10895 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
10896 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
10897
10898 @item set history save off
10899 Stop recording command history in a file.
10900
10901 @cindex history size
10902 @kindex set history size
10903 @item set history size @var{size}
10904 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
10905 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
10906 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
10907 @end table
10908
10909 @cindex history expansion
10910 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
10911 @ifset have-readline-appendices
10912 @xref{Event Designators}.
10913 @end ifset
10914
10915 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
10916 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
10917 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
10918 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
10919 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
10920 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
10921 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
10922
10923 The commands to control history expansion are:
10924
10925 @table @code
10926 @kindex set history expansion
10927 @item set history expansion on
10928 @itemx set history expansion
10929 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
10930
10931 @item set history expansion off
10932 Disable history expansion.
10933
10934 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
10935 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
10936 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
10937 @ifset have-readline-appendices
10938 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
10939 @end ifset
10940
10941 @c @group
10942 @kindex show history
10943 @item show history
10944 @itemx show history filename
10945 @itemx show history save
10946 @itemx show history size
10947 @itemx show history expansion
10948 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
10949 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
10950 @c @end group
10951 @end table
10952
10953 @table @code
10954 @kindex show commands
10955 @item show commands
10956 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
10957
10958 @item show commands @var{n}
10959 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
10960
10961 @item show commands +
10962 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
10963 @end table
10964
10965 @node Screen Size
10966 @section Screen size
10967 @cindex size of screen
10968 @cindex pauses in output
10969
10970 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
10971 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
10972 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
10973 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
10974 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
10975 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
10976 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
10977 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
10978
10979 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the termcap data base
10980 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
10981 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
10982 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
10983 width} commands:
10984
10985 @table @code
10986 @kindex set height
10987 @kindex set width
10988 @kindex show width
10989 @kindex show height
10990 @item set height @var{lpp}
10991 @itemx show height
10992 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
10993 @itemx show width
10994 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
10995 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
10996 commands display the current settings.
10997
10998 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
10999 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
11000 file or to an editor buffer.
11001
11002 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11003 from wrapping its output.
11004 @end table
11005
11006 @node Numbers
11007 @section Numbers
11008 @cindex number representation
11009 @cindex entering numbers
11010
11011 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in @value{GDBN} by
11012 the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with @samp{0}, decimal
11013 numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers begin with @samp{0x}.
11014 Numbers that begin with none of these are, by default, entered in base
11015 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
11016 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
11017 both input and output with the @code{set radix} command.
11018
11019 @table @code
11020 @kindex set input-radix
11021 @item set input-radix @var{base}
11022 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11023 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11024 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11025 example, any of
11026
11027 @smallexample
11028 set radix 012
11029 set radix 10.
11030 set radix 0xa
11031 @end smallexample
11032
11033 @noindent
11034 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11035 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11036
11037 @kindex set output-radix
11038 @item set output-radix @var{base}
11039 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11040 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11041 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11042
11043 @kindex show input-radix
11044 @item show input-radix
11045 Display the current default base for numeric input.
11046
11047 @kindex show output-radix
11048 @item show output-radix
11049 Display the current default base for numeric display.
11050 @end table
11051
11052 @node Messages/Warnings
11053 @section Optional warnings and messages
11054
11055 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are running
11056 on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose} command.
11057 This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy internal operation, so
11058 you will not think it has crashed.
11059
11060 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11061 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11062 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11063
11064 @table @code
11065 @kindex set verbose
11066 @item set verbose on
11067 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11068
11069 @item set verbose off
11070 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11071
11072 @kindex show verbose
11073 @item show verbose
11074 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11075 @end table
11076
11077 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an object
11078 file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may find
11079 this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading symbol files}).
11080
11081 @table @code
11082 @kindex set complaints
11083 @item set complaints @var{limit}
11084 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of unusual
11085 symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set @var{limit} to
11086 zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number to prevent
11087 complaints from being suppressed.
11088
11089 @kindex show complaints
11090 @item show complaints
11091 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
11092 @end table
11093
11094 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11095 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11096 you try to run a program which is already running:
11097
11098 @example
11099 (@value{GDBP}) run
11100 The program being debugged has been started already.
11101 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11102 @end example
11103
11104 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11105 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11106
11107 @table @code
11108 @kindex set confirm
11109 @cindex flinching
11110 @cindex confirmation
11111 @cindex stupid questions
11112 @item set confirm off
11113 Disables confirmation requests.
11114
11115 @item set confirm on
11116 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11117
11118 @kindex show confirm
11119 @item show confirm
11120 Displays state of confirmation requests.
11121 @end table
11122
11123 @node Sequences
11124 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11125
11126 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
11127 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of commands
11128 for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command files.
11129
11130 @menu
11131 * Define:: User-defined commands
11132 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11133 * Command Files:: Command files
11134 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
11135 @end menu
11136
11137 @node Define
11138 @section User-defined commands
11139
11140 @cindex user-defined command
11141 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to which
11142 you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the @code{define}
11143 command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments separated by whitespace.
11144 Arguments are accessed within the user command via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}.
11145 A trivial example:
11146
11147 @smallexample
11148 define adder
11149 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11150 @end smallexample
11151
11152 @noindent To execute the command use:
11153
11154 @smallexample
11155 adder 1 2 3
11156 @end smallexample
11157
11158 @noindent This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
11159 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
11160 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11161 functions calls.
11162
11163 @table @code
11164 @kindex define
11165 @item define @var{commandname}
11166 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11167 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11168
11169 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11170 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11171 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11172
11173 @kindex if
11174 @kindex else
11175 @item if
11176 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11177 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11178 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11179 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11180 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11181 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11182
11183 @kindex while
11184 @item while
11185 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11186 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11187 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11188 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11189 evaluates to true.
11190
11191 @kindex document
11192 @item document @var{commandname}
11193 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
11194 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11195 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11196 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11197 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
11198 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11199
11200 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11201 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11202 does not change the documentation.
11203
11204 @kindex help user-defined
11205 @item help user-defined
11206 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11207 (if any) for each.
11208
11209 @kindex show user
11210 @item show user
11211 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
11212 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but not its
11213 documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
11214 definitions for all user-defined commands.
11215 @end table
11216
11217 When user-defined commands are executed, the
11218 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
11219 stops execution of the user-defined command.
11220
11221 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
11222 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
11223 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
11224 messages when used in a user-defined command.
11225
11226 @node Hooks
11227 @section User-defined command hooks
11228 @cindex command files
11229
11230 You may define @emph{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
11231 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11232 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11233 before that command.
11234
11235 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
11236 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11237 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11238 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11239
11240 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11241 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11242 you could define:
11243
11244 @example
11245 define hook-stop
11246 handle SIGALRM nopass
11247 end
11248
11249 define hook-run
11250 handle SIGALRM pass
11251 end
11252
11253 define hook-continue
11254 handle SIGLARM pass
11255 end
11256 @end example
11257
11258 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11259 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11260 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11261 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11262 @c or not?
11263 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11264 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11265 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11266
11267 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11268 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11269
11270 @node Command Files
11271 @section Command files
11272
11273 @cindex command files
11274 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11275 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11276 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
11277 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11278
11279 @cindex init file
11280 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
11281 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
11282 @dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix, or
11283 @file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. @value{GDBN} reads the init file (if
11284 any) in your home directory, then processes command line options and
11285 operands, and then reads the init file (if any) in the current working
11286 directory. This is so the init file in your home directory can set
11287 options (such as @code{set complaints}) which affect the processing of
11288 the command line options and operands. The init files are not executed
11289 if you use the @samp{-nx} option; @pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}.
11290
11291 @cindex init file name
11292 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11293 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11294 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
11295 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
11296 environments with special init file names:
11297
11298 @kindex .vxgdbinit
11299 @itemize @bullet
11300 @item
11301 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @samp{.vxgdbinit}
11302
11303 @kindex .os68gdbinit
11304 @item
11305 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @samp{.os68gdbinit}
11306
11307 @kindex .esgdbinit
11308 @item
11309 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @samp{.esgdbinit}
11310 @end itemize
11311
11312 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
11313 @code{source} command:
11314
11315 @table @code
11316 @kindex source
11317 @item source @var{filename}
11318 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
11319 @end table
11320
11321 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
11322 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
11323 of the command file.
11324
11325 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
11326 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
11327 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
11328 when called from command files.
11329
11330 @node Output
11331 @section Commands for controlled output
11332
11333 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
11334 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
11335 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
11336 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
11337 want.
11338
11339 @table @code
11340 @kindex echo
11341 @item echo @var{text}
11342 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
11343 @c because it is not in ANSI.
11344 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
11345 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
11346 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
11347 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
11348 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
11349 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
11350 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
11351 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
11352 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
11353
11354 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
11355 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
11356
11357 @example
11358 echo This is some text\n\
11359 which is continued\n\
11360 onto several lines.\n
11361 @end example
11362
11363 produces the same output as
11364
11365 @example
11366 echo This is some text\n
11367 echo which is continued\n
11368 echo onto several lines.\n
11369 @end example
11370
11371 @kindex output
11372 @item output @var{expression}
11373 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
11374 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
11375 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
11376 on expressions.
11377
11378 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
11379 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
11380 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
11381 formats}, for more information.
11382
11383 @kindex printf
11384 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
11385 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
11386 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
11387 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
11388 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
11389 subroutine
11390
11391 @example
11392 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
11393 @end example
11394
11395 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
11396
11397 @smallexample
11398 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
11399 @end smallexample
11400
11401 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
11402 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
11403 letter.
11404 @end table
11405
11406 @node Emacs
11407 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
11408
11409 @cindex Emacs
11410 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
11411 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
11412 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
11413 @value{GDBN}.
11414
11415 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
11416 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
11417 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
11418 created Emacs buffer.
11419 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
11420
11421 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
11422 things:
11423
11424 @itemize @bullet
11425 @item
11426 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
11427 @end itemize
11428
11429 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
11430 and output done by the program you are debugging.
11431
11432 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
11433 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
11434 in this way.
11435
11436 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
11437 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
11438 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
11439 stop.
11440
11441 @itemize @bullet
11442 @item
11443 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
11444 @end itemize
11445
11446 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
11447 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
11448 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
11449 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
11450 and the source.
11451
11452 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
11453 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
11454
11455 @quotation
11456 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
11457 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
11458 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
11459 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
11460 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
11461 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
11462 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
11463 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
11464 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
11465 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
11466
11467 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
11468 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
11469 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
11470 @end quotation
11471
11472 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
11473 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
11474 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
11475 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
11476
11477 @example
11478 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
11479 @end example
11480
11481 @noindent
11482 (preceded by @kbd{ESC ESC}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
11483 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
11484 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
11485
11486 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
11487 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
11488
11489 @table @kbd
11490 @item C-h m
11491 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
11492
11493 @item M-s
11494 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
11495 update the display window to show the current file and location.
11496
11497 @item M-n
11498 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
11499 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
11500 to show the current file and location.
11501
11502 @item M-i
11503 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
11504 display window accordingly.
11505
11506 @item M-x gdb-nexti
11507 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
11508 display window accordingly.
11509
11510 @item C-c C-f
11511 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
11512 @code{finish} command.
11513
11514 @item M-c
11515 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
11516 command.
11517
11518 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
11519
11520 @item M-u
11521 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
11522 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
11523 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
11524
11525 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
11526
11527 @item M-d
11528 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
11529 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
11530
11531 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
11532
11533 @item C-x &
11534 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
11535 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
11536 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
11537 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
11538 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
11539
11540 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
11541 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
11542 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
11543 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
11544 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
11545 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
11546 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
11547 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
11548 @end table
11549
11550 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
11551 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
11552
11553 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
11554 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
11555 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
11556 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
11557 frame.
11558
11559 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
11560 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
11561 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
11562 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
11563 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
11564 to correspond properly with the code.
11565
11566 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
11567 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
11568 @ignore
11569 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
11570 @kindex Epoch
11571 @kindex inspect
11572
11573 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
11574 called the @code{epoch}
11575 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
11576 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
11577 each value is printed in its own window.
11578 @end ignore
11579
11580 @node GDB Bugs
11581 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
11582 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
11583 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
11584
11585 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
11586
11587 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
11588 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
11589 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
11590 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
11591
11592 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
11593 information that enables us to fix the bug.
11594
11595 @menu
11596 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
11597 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
11598 @end menu
11599
11600 @node Bug Criteria
11601 @section Have you found a bug?
11602 @cindex bug criteria
11603
11604 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
11605
11606 @itemize @bullet
11607 @cindex fatal signal
11608 @cindex debugger crash
11609 @cindex crash of debugger
11610 @item
11611 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
11612 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
11613
11614 @cindex error on valid input
11615 @item
11616 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
11617 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
11618 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
11619
11620 @cindex invalid input
11621 @item
11622 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
11623 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
11624 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
11625 for traditional practice''.
11626
11627 @item
11628 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
11629 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
11630 @end itemize
11631
11632 @node Bug Reporting
11633 @section How to report bugs
11634 @cindex bug reports
11635 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
11636
11637 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
11638 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
11639 contact that organization first.
11640
11641 You can find contact information for many support companies and
11642 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
11643 distribution.
11644 @c should add a web page ref...
11645
11646 In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
11647 @value{GDBN} to this addresses:
11648
11649 @example
11650 bug-gdb@@prep.ai.mit.edu
11651 @end example
11652
11653 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
11654 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
11655 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
11656 @samp{bug-gdb}.
11657
11658 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
11659 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
11660 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
11661 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
11662 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
11663 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
11664 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
11665 bug reports to the mailing list.
11666
11667 As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
11668
11669 @example
11670 @sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
11671 Free Software Foundation Inc.
11672 59 Temple Place - Suite 330
11673 Boston, MA 02111-1307
11674 USA
11675 @end example
11676
11677 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
11678 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
11679 fact or leave it out, state it!
11680
11681 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
11682 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
11683 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
11684 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
11685 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
11686 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
11687 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
11688 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
11689 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
11690
11691 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
11692 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
11693 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
11694 self-contained.
11695
11696 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
11697 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
11698 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
11699 bugs properly.
11700
11701 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
11702
11703 @itemize @bullet
11704 @item
11705 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
11706 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
11707 version}.
11708
11709 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
11710 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
11711
11712 @item
11713 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
11714 version number.
11715
11716 @item
11717 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
11718 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
11719
11720 @item
11721 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
11722 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
11723 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
11724 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
11725 compilers.
11726
11727 @item
11728 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
11729 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
11730 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
11731 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
11732
11733 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
11734 and then we might not encounter the bug.
11735
11736 @item
11737 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
11738 reproduce the bug.
11739
11740 @item
11741 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
11742 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
11743
11744 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
11745 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
11746 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
11747 a chance to make a mistake.
11748
11749 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
11750 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
11751 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
11752 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
11753 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
11754 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
11755 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
11756 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
11757
11758 @item
11759 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
11760 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
11761 it by context, not by line number.
11762
11763 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
11764 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
11765
11766 @end itemize
11767
11768 Here are some things that are not necessary:
11769
11770 @itemize @bullet
11771 @item
11772 A description of the envelope of the bug.
11773
11774 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
11775 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
11776 changes will not affect it.
11777
11778 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
11779 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
11780 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
11781 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
11782
11783 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
11784 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
11785 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
11786 less time, and so on.
11787
11788 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
11789 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
11790
11791 @item
11792 A patch for the bug.
11793
11794 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
11795 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
11796 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
11797 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
11798
11799 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
11800 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
11801 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
11802 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
11803
11804 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
11805 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
11806 help us to understand.
11807
11808 @item
11809 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
11810
11811 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
11812 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
11813 @end itemize
11814
11815 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
11816 @c and consists of the two following files:
11817 @c rluser.texinfo
11818 @c inc-hist.texinfo
11819 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
11820 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
11821 @include rluser.texinfo
11822 @include inc-hist.texinfo
11823
11824
11825 @node Formatting Documentation
11826 @appendix Formatting Documentation
11827
11828 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
11829 @cindex reference card
11830 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
11831 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
11832 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
11833 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
11834 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
11835 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
11836
11837 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
11838 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
11839
11840 @example
11841 make refcard.dvi
11842 @end example
11843
11844 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
11845 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
11846 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
11847 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
11848 your @sc{dvi} output program.
11849
11850 @cindex documentation
11851
11852 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
11853 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
11854 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
11855 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
11856 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
11857 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
11858
11859 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
11860 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
11861 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
11862 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
11863 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
11864 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
11865 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
11866 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
11867
11868 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
11869 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
11870 @code{makeinfo}.
11871
11872 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
11873 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
11874 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
11875
11876 @example
11877 cd gdb
11878 make gdb.info
11879 @end example
11880
11881 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
11882 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
11883 Texinfo definitions file.
11884
11885 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
11886 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
11887 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
11888 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
11889 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
11890 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
11891 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
11892
11893 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
11894 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
11895 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
11896 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
11897 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
11898 directory.
11899
11900 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
11901 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
11902 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
11903 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
11904
11905 @example
11906 make gdb.dvi
11907 @end example
11908
11909 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
11910
11911 @node Installing GDB
11912 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
11913 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
11914 @cindex installation
11915
11916 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
11917 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
11918 build the @code{gdb} program.
11919 @iftex
11920 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
11921 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
11922 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
11923 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
11924 @end iftex
11925
11926 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
11927 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
11928 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
11929
11930 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
11931 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
11932
11933 @table @code
11934 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
11935 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
11936
11937 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
11938 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
11939
11940 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
11941 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
11942
11943 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
11944 @sc{gnu} include files
11945
11946 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
11947 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
11948
11949 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
11950 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
11951
11952 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
11953 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
11954
11955 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
11956 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
11957
11958 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
11959 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
11960 @end table
11961
11962 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
11963 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
11964 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
11965
11966 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
11967 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
11968 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
11969 argument.
11970
11971 For example:
11972
11973 @example
11974 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
11975 ./configure @var{host}
11976 make
11977 @end example
11978
11979 @noindent
11980 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
11981 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
11982 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
11983 correct value by examining your system.)
11984
11985 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
11986 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
11987 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
11988 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
11989
11990 @need 750
11991 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
11992 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
11993 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
11994
11995 @example
11996 sh configure @var{host}
11997 @end example
11998
11999 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12000 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12001 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12002 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12003 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12004
12005 You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12006 subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12007 configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12008
12009 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12010 the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12011
12012 @example
12013 @group
12014 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12015 ../configure @var{host}
12016 @end group
12017 @end example
12018
12019 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12020 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12021 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12022 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12023 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12024
12025 @menu
12026 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12027 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12028 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12029 @end menu
12030
12031 @node Separate Objdir
12032 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12033
12034 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12035 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12036 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12037 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12038 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12039 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12040 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12041 program specified there.
12042
12043 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12044 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12045 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12046 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12047 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12048 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12049
12050 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
12051 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12052
12053 @example
12054 @group
12055 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12056 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12057 cd ../gdb-sun4
12058 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12059 make
12060 @end group
12061 @end example
12062
12063 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12064 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12065 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12066 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12067 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12068 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12069
12070 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
12071 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12072 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12073 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
12074 You specify a cross-debugging target by
12075 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12076
12077 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12078 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12079 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12080
12081 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12082 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12083 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12084 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12085 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12086
12087 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12088 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12089 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12090 with each other.
12091
12092 @node Config Names
12093 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12094
12095 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12096 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12097 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12098 of information in the following pattern:
12099
12100 @example
12101 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12102 @end example
12103
12104 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12105 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12106 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12107
12108 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12109 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12110 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12111 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12112 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12113 abbreviations---for example:
12114
12115 @smallexample
12116 % sh config.sub i386-linux
12117 i386-pc-linux-gnu
12118 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
12119 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12120 % sh config.sub hp9k700
12121 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12122 % sh config.sub sun4
12123 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12124 % sh config.sub sun3
12125 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12126 % sh config.sub i986v
12127 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12128 @end smallexample
12129
12130 @noindent
12131 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12132 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12133
12134 @node Configure Options
12135 @section @code{configure} options
12136
12137 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12138 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12139 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12140 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12141
12142 @example
12143 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12144 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12145 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12146 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12147 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12148 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12149 @var{host}
12150 @end example
12151
12152 @noindent
12153 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12154 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12155 @samp{--}.
12156
12157 @table @code
12158 @item --help
12159 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12160
12161 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
12162 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12163 @file{@var{dir}}.
12164
12165 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12166 Configure the source to install programs under directory
12167 @file{@var{dir}}.
12168
12169 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12170 @need 2000
12171 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12172 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12173 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12174 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12175 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
12176 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12177 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12178 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12179 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
12180 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12181 @var{dirname}.
12182
12183 @item --norecursion
12184 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12185 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12186
12187 @item --target=@var{target}
12188 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12189 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12190 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12191
12192 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12193
12194 @item @var{host} @dots{}
12195 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12196
12197 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12198 @end table
12199
12200 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12201 needed for special purposes only.
12202
12203 @node Index
12204 @unnumbered Index
12205
12206 @printindex cp
12207
12208 @tex
12209 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
12210 % meantime:
12211 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12212 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12213 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12214 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12215 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12216 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12217 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12218 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12219 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12220 \page\colophon
12221 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12222 @end tex
12223
12224 @contents
12225 @bye
This page took 0.338739 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.